blob: 51f29649b740115d2c25e0503701e4c59b7470ff [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaubab84d42014-12-31 22:22:28 +01005 version 1.5.10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaubab84d42014-12-31 22:22:28 +01007 2014/12/31
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
1151peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1152 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1153 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1154 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1155 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1156 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1157 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1158
1159 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1160 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1161
1162 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1163 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1164 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1165 across all peers.
1166
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001167 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1168 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1169 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1170
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001171 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001173 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1174 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1175 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001176
1177 backend mybackend
1178 mode tcp
1179 balance roundrobin
1180 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1181 stick on src
1182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001183 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1184 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001185
1186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1191 - defaults <name>
1192 - frontend <name>
1193 - backend <name>
1194 - listen <name>
1195
1196A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1197its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1198section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001199section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200
1201A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1202connections.
1203
1204A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1205to forward incoming connections.
1206
1207A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1208parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1211'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1212case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1213
1214Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1215logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1216proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1217However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1218name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1219
1220Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1221and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001223protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1224modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1225arbitrary criteria.
1226
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001227In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1228a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1229the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1230
1231 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1232 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1233 between responses and new requests.
1234
1235 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1236 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1237 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1238 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1239
1240 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1241 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1242 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1243
1244 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1245 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1246 client-facing connection remains open.
1247
1248 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1249 after the end of the response.
1250
1251The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1252frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1253following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1254weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1255
1256 Backend mode
1257
1258 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1261 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1262 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1263 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1264 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1265 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1266 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1273--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001275The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1276limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1277they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1278limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001280option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001281and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1282with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1283specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001285
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1287------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1288acl - X X X
1289appsession - - X X
1290backlog X X X -
1291balance X - X X
1292bind - X X -
1293bind-process X X X X
1294block - X X X
1295capture cookie - X X -
1296capture request header - X X -
1297capture response header - X X -
1298clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001299compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1301cookie X - X X
1302default-server X - X X
1303default_backend X X X -
1304description - X X X
1305disabled X X X X
1306dispatch - - X X
1307enabled X X X X
1308errorfile X X X X
1309errorloc X X X X
1310errorloc302 X X X X
1311-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1312errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001313force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314fullconn X - X X
1315grace X X X X
1316hash-type X - X X
1317http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001318http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001319http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001321http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001322http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001323id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001324ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001325log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001326log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001327max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001328maxconn X X X -
1329mode X X X X
1330monitor fail - X X -
1331monitor-net X X X -
1332monitor-uri X X X -
1333option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1334option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1335option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1336option allbackups (*) X - X X
1337option checkcache (*) X - X X
1338option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1339option contstats (*) X X X -
1340option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1341option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1342option forceclose (*) X X X X
1343-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1344option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001345option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001346option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001347option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001348option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001349option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001350option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1351option httpchk X - X X
1352option httpclose (*) X X X X
1353option httplog X X X X
1354option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001355option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001356option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1358option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1359option logasap (*) X X X -
1360option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001361option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001362option nolinger (*) X X X X
1363option originalto X X X X
1364option persist (*) X - X X
1365option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001366option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001367option smtpchk X - X X
1368option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1369option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1370option splice-request (*) X X X X
1371option splice-response (*) X X X X
1372option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1373option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1374-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001375option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1377option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1378option tcpka X X X X
1379option tcplog X X X X
1380option transparent (*) X - X X
1381persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1382rate-limit sessions X X X -
1383redirect - X X X
1384redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1385redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1386reqadd - X X X
1387reqallow - X X X
1388reqdel - X X X
1389reqdeny - X X X
1390reqiallow - X X X
1391reqidel - X X X
1392reqideny - X X X
1393reqipass - X X X
1394reqirep - X X X
1395reqisetbe - X X X
1396reqitarpit - X X X
1397reqpass - X X X
1398reqrep - X X X
1399-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1400reqsetbe - X X X
1401reqtarpit - X X X
1402retries X - X X
1403rspadd - X X X
1404rspdel - X X X
1405rspdeny - X X X
1406rspidel - X X X
1407rspideny - X X X
1408rspirep - X X X
1409rsprep - X X X
1410server - - X X
1411source X - X X
1412srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001413stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001414stats auth X - X X
1415stats enable X - X X
1416stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001417stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418stats realm X - X X
1419stats refresh X - X X
1420stats scope X - X X
1421stats show-desc X - X X
1422stats show-legends X - X X
1423stats show-node X - X X
1424stats uri X - X X
1425-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1426stick match - - X X
1427stick on - - X X
1428stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001429stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001430stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001431tcp-check connect - - X X
1432tcp-check expect - - X X
1433tcp-check send - - X X
1434tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001435tcp-request connection - X X -
1436tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001437tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001438tcp-response content - - X X
1439tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001440timeout check X - X X
1441timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001442timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001443timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1444timeout connect X - X X
1445timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1447timeout http-request X X X X
1448timeout queue X - X X
1449timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001450timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1452timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001453timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001454transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001455unique-id-format X X X -
1456unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001457use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001458use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1460 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1464---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465
1466This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1467
1468
1469acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1470 Declare or complete an access list.
1471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1472 no | yes | yes | yes
1473 Example:
1474 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1475 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1476 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001478 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001481appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1482 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 no | no | yes | yes
1486 Arguments :
1487 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1488 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 checked in each cookie value.
1492
1493 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1494 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1495 milliseconds.
1496
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001497 request-learn
1498 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1499 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1500 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1501 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1502 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1503 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1504
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001505 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1506 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1507 data following this prefix.
1508
1509 Example :
1510 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1511
1512 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1513 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1514
1515 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1516 2 modes are currently supported :
1517 - path-parameters :
1518 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1519 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1520 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1521 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1522 - query-string :
1523 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1524 query string.
1525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001526 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1527 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1528 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1529 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001530 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1531 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1532 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1534 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1535
1536 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001538 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1539 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1540 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542 Example :
1543 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1544
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001545 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1546 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001547
1548
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001549backlog <conns>
1550 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1552 yes | yes | yes | no
1553 Arguments :
1554 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1555 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001556 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001557
1558 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1559 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1560 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1561 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1562 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1563 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1564 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1565 backlog parameter.
1566
1567 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1568 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1569 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1570
1571 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1572
1573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001575balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001576 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1578 yes | no | yes | yes
1579 Arguments :
1580 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1581 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1582 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1583 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1584
1585 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1586 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1587 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1588 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001589 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001590 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001591 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1592 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1593 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1594 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1595 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1596 it, so that you don't worry.
1597
1598 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1599 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1600 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1601 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1602 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1603 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1604 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1605 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001607 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1608 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1609 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1610 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1611 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1612 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1613 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1614 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1615
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001616 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001617 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001618 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1619 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001621 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1622 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1623 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1624 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1625 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001626 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1627 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1628 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1629 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1630 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1631 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001633 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1634 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1635 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1636 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1637 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1638 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1639 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1640 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001641 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001643 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1644 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1645 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001647 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1648 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1649 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1650 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1651 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1652 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1653 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1654 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1655 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1656 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1657 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1658 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001660 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001661 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1662 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1663 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1664 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1665 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1666 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1667 URIs start with a leading "/".
1668
1669 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1670 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1671 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1672 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001674 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001675 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1676
1677 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1679 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001680 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1681 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1682 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1683 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001684 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001685 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1686 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001687
1688 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1689 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1690 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1691 server will receive the request.
1692
1693 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1694 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1695 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1696 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1697 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001698 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1699 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1700 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001702 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1703 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1704 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1705 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1706 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001708 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1710 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1711 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1712
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001713 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1714 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1715 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1716
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001717 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001718 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001719 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1720 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1721 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1722 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1723 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1724 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001725 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001726 used instead.
1727
1728 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1729 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1730 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1731 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1732
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001733 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1734 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1735 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1736
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001737 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001740 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1741 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001742
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001743 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1744 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1745 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746
1747 Examples :
1748 balance roundrobin
1749 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001750 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001751 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1752 balance hdr(host)
1753 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001754
1755 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1756 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001758 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001759 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1760 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1761 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1762 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1763
1764 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1765 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1766 defaults to 16 kB.
1767
1768 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1769 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1770
1771 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1772 Round Robin.
1773
1774 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1775 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1776 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1777 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1778
1779 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1780
1781 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001782 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001783 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1784 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1785 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001787 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1788 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789
1790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001791bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1792bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1795 no | yes | yes | no
1796 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001797 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1798 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1799 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1800 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001801 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001802 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1803 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1804 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1805 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1806 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1807 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1808 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001809 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1810 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1811 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1812 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1813 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1814 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1815 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001816 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1817 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1818 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001819 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1820 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1821 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1822 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001823
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001824 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1825 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001826 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1827 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1828 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001829 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1830 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1831 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1832 the range.
1833
1834 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1835 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1836 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1837 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1838 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1839 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1840 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001841 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001842 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001844 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1845 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1846 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1847 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1848 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1849 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1850 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1851 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001853 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1854 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1855 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1856 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1859 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1860 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1861 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1862 in a frontend.
1863
1864 Example :
1865 listen http_proxy
1866 bind :80,:443
1867 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001868 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001870 listen http_https_proxy
1871 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001872 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001873
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001874 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1875 bind ipv6@:80
1876 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1877 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1878
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001879 listen external_bind_app1
1880 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1881
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001882 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001883 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884
1885
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001886bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001887 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1889 yes | yes | yes | yes
1890 Arguments :
1891 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1892 may be used to override a default value.
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895 option may be combined with other numbers.
1896
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001897 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001898 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1899 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1900 missing from all processes.
1901
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001902 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001903 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001904 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1905 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1906 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1907 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001908
1909 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1910 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1911 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1912 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1913 and 'even' instances.
1914
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001915 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1916 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1917 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1918 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001919
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001920 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1921 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1922
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001923 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1924 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1925 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1926
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1928 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1929
1930 Example :
1931 listen app_ip1
1932 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001933 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001934
1935 listen app_ip2
1936 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001937 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001938
1939 listen management
1940 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001941 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001943 listen management
1944 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1945 bind-process 1-4
1946
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001947 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001948
1949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950block { if | unless } <condition>
1951 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1953 no | yes | yes | yes
1954
1955 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1956 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001957 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001958 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1960 "block" statements per instance.
1961
1962 Example:
1963 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1964 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1965 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1966 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001968 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
1970
1971capture cookie <name> len <length>
1972 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1974 no | yes | yes | no
1975 Arguments :
1976 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1977 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1978 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1979 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1980 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1981
1982 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1983 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1984 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1985 right if it exceeds <length>.
1986
1987 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1988 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1989 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1990 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1991
1992 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1993 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1994 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1995
1996 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1997 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1998 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001999 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2000 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2001 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
2003 Example:
2004 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2005
2006 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002007 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
2009
2010capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002011 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | yes | yes | no
2014 Arguments :
2015 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002016 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2018 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2019 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2020
2021 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2022 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2023 it exceeds <length>.
2024
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002025 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2027 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002028 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2029 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2030 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2031 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002032 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002033 environments to find where the request came from.
2034
2035 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2036 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2037 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2038 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002040 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2041 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2042 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2043 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2044 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045
2046 Example:
2047 capture request header Host len 15
2048 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2049 capture request header Referrer len 15
2050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002051 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 about logging.
2053
2054
2055capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002056 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2058 no | yes | yes | no
2059 Arguments :
2060 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002061 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2063 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2064 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2065
2066 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2067 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2068 it exceeds <length>.
2069
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002070 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2072 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2073 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002074 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2075 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2076 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2077 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002079 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2080 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2081 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2082 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2083 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085 Example:
2086 capture response header Content-length len 9
2087 capture response header Location len 15
2088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002089 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 about logging.
2091
2092
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002093clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2096 yes | yes | yes | no
2097 Arguments :
2098 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2100 as explained at the top of this document.
2101
2102 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2103 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2104 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2105 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2106 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2107 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2108 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2109 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002110 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2112 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2113
2114 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2115 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2116 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2117 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2118 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2119 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2120
2121 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2122 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2123
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002124 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2125 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002127compression algo <algorithm> ...
2128compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002129compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002130 Enable HTTP compression.
2131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2132 yes | yes | yes | yes
2133 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002134 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2135 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2136 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2137
2138 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002139 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002140 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2141 data.
2142
2143 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2144 support for zlib was built in.
2145
2146 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2147 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2148 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2149 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2150 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2151 in.
2152
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002153 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002154 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002155 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2156 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2157 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2158 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2159 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002160
2161 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2162 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2163 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2164 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2165 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002166 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2167 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2168 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2169 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2170 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002171 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2172 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002173
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002174 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002175 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2176 "Accept-Encoding" header
2177 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002178 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002179 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2180 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002181 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2182 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2183 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2184 "multipart"
2185 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2186 header
2187 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2188 and later
2189 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2190 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002191
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002192 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2193 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002194
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002195 Examples :
2196 compression algo gzip
2197 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2202 yes | no | yes | yes
2203 Arguments :
2204 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2205 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2206 as explained at the top of this document.
2207
2208 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002209 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002210 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002211 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2212 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2213 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2214 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2215
2216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2222
2223 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2224 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2225 instead.
2226
2227 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2228 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2229
2230
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002231cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002232 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2233 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2236 yes | no | yes | yes
2237 Arguments :
2238 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2239 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2240 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2241 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2242 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2243 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2244 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2245 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2246 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2247
2248 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2249 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2250 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2251 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2252 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2253 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2254 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2255 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2256 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2257 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2258 "insert" and "prefix".
2259
2260 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002261 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002262
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002263 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002264 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2265 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2266 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2267 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2268 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2269 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2270 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2271 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2272 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2273 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
2275 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2276 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2277 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2278 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2279 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2280 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2281 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2282 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2283 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2284 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002285 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2286 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2287 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002289 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2290 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2291 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002292 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2293 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2294 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2295 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002296 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2297 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2298 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
2300 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2301 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2302 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2303 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2304 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2305 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2306 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2307 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2308 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2309
2310 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2311 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2312 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2313 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2314 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2315 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2316 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2317 persistence cookie in the cache.
2318 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2319
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002320 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2321 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2322 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2323 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2324 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2325 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2326 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2327 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2328 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2329 they logout.
2330
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002331 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2332 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2333 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2334 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2335
2336 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2337 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2338 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2339 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2340 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2341 this attribute.
2342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002343 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002344 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002345 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2346 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2347 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2348 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2349 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2350 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002351
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002352 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2353 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2354 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2355 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2356 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2357 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2358 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2359 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2360 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2361 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2362 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2363 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2364 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2365 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2366 the site.
2367
2368 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2369 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2370 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2371 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2372 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2373 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2374 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2375 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2376 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2377 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2378 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2379 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2380 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2381 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2382 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2383 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2386 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2387 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2388 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390 Examples :
2391 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2392 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2393 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002394 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002396 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002397 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002400default-server [param*]
2401 Change default options for a server in a backend
2402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2403 yes | no | yes | yes
2404 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002405 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2406 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2407 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2408 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002409
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002410 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002411 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2412
2413 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416default_backend <backend>
2417 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2419 yes | yes | yes | no
2420 Arguments :
2421 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2422
2423 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2424 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2425 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2426 will catch all undetermined requests.
2427
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 Example :
2429
2430 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2431 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2432 default_backend dynamic
2433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002434 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002437description <string>
2438 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 no | yes | yes | yes
2441 Arguments : string
2442
2443 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2444 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2445 it describes.
2446 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2447
2448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449disabled
2450 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 yes | yes | yes | yes
2453 Arguments : none
2454
2455 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2456 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2457 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2458 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2459 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2460 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2461 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2462
2463 See also : "enabled"
2464
2465
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002466dispatch <address>:<port>
2467 Set a default server address
2468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2469 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002471
2472 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2473 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2474 during start-up.
2475
2476 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2477 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2478 possible with normal servers.
2479
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002480 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002481 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2482 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2483 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2484 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2485
2486 See also : "server"
2487
2488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489enabled
2490 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2492 yes | yes | yes | yes
2493 Arguments : none
2494
2495 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2496 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2497
2498 See also : "disabled"
2499
2500
2501errorfile <code> <file>
2502 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 yes | yes | yes | yes
2505 Arguments :
2506 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002507 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508
2509 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002510 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002512 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2513 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514
2515 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2516 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2517 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2518
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002519 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2522 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2523 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2524 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2525
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002526 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2527 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2528 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2529 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2530 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2531 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2534 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2535 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002536 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2538
2539 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2540
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002541 Example :
2542 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002543 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002544 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2545 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547
2548errorloc <code> <url>
2549errorloc302 <code> <url>
2550 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2552 yes | yes | yes | yes
2553 Arguments :
2554 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002555 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002556
2557 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2558 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2559 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2560 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2561 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2562
2563 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2564 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2565 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2566
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002567 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002569 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2570 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2571 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2572 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2573 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2574 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2575 request.
2576
2577 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2578
2579
2580errorloc303 <code> <url>
2581 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 yes | yes | yes | yes
2584 Arguments :
2585 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2586 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2587
2588 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2589 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2590 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2591 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2592 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2593
2594 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2595 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2596 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2597
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002598 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002600 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2601 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2602 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2603 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002604 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605
2606 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2607
2608
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002609force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2610 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 no | yes | yes | yes
2613
2614 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2615 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2616 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2617 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2618 marked down for maintenance operations.
2619
2620 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2621 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2622 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2623 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2624 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2625 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2626 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2627 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2628 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2629
2630 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2631 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2632 is used.
2633
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002634 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002635 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002636
2637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638fullconn <conns>
2639 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2641 yes | no | yes | yes
2642 Arguments :
2643 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2644 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2645
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002646 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002648 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2650 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2651 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2652 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2653 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002654 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002656 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2657 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002658 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2659 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2660 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662 Example :
2663 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2664 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2665 # connections.
2666 backend dynamic
2667 fullconn 10000
2668 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2669 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2670
2671 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2672
2673
2674grace <time>
2675 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002677 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678 Arguments :
2679 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2680 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2681 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2682
2683 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2684 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002685 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2687
2688 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2689 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2690 simplify it.
2691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002693hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002694 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2696 yes | no | yes | yes
2697 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002698 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2699 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002700
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002701 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2702 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2703 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2704 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2705 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2706 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2707 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2708 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2709 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2710 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002711
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002712 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2713 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2714 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2715 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2716 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2717 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2718 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2719 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2720 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2721 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2722 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2723 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2724 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002725 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2726 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002727
2728 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2729
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002730 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002731 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2732 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2733 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002734 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2735 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2736 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002737
2738 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2739 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002740 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2741 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2742 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2743 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2744
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002745 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2746 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2747 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2748 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2749 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2750 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2751 parameter.
2752
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002753 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2754
2755 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2756 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2757 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2758 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2759 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2760 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2761 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2762 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2763 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2764 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2765 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2766 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002767
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002768 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2769 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2770 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002771
2772 See also : "balance", "server"
2773
2774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775http-check disable-on-404
2776 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002779 Arguments : none
2780
2781 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2782 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2783 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2784 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2785 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2786 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2787 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2788 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2790 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2791 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2792
2793 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2794
2795
2796http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002797 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002800 Arguments :
2801 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2802 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002803 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002804 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2805 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2806 details on the supported keywords.
2807
2808 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2809 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2810 with the usual backslash ('\').
2811
2812 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2813 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2814 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2815 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2816 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2817
2818 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002819 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002820 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2821 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2822 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2823
2824 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002825 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002826 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2827 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2828 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2829 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2830
2831 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002832 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2834 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2835 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2836 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2837 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2838 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2839 trace).
2840
2841 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002842 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002843 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2844 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2845 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2846 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2847 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2848 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2849
2850 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2851 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2852 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2853 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2854 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2855 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2856 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2857 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2858
2859 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2860 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2861
2862 Examples :
2863 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002864 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002865
2866 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002867 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002868
2869 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002870 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002871
2872 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002873 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002874
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002875 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002876
2877
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002878http-check send-state
2879 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2881 yes | no | yes | yes
2882 Arguments : none
2883
2884 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2885 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2886 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2887 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2888 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2889
2890 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2891 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2892 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2893 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2894 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2895 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2896 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2897 checked in multiple backends.
2898
2899 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2900 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2901
2902 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2903 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2904 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2905 one fails.
2906
2907 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2908 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2909 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2910
2911 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2912 server's queue.
2913
2914 Example of a header received by the application server :
2915 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2916 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2917
2918 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2919
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002920http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002921 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002922 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002923 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2924 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002925 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2926 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2927 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2928 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2929 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2930 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002932 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2933
2934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2935 no | yes | yes | yes
2936
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002937 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2938 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2939 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2940 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2941 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002942
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002943 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2944 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2945 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2946
2947 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2948 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2949 are evaluated.
2950
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002951 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2952 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2953 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2954 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2955 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2956 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2957 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2958 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2959 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002960 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002961 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2962
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002963 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2964 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2965 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2966 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2967 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2968
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002969 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2970 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2971 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002972 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2973 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002974
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002975 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2976 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2977 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2978 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2979 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2980 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2981 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2982 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2983
2984 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2985 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2986 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreaufcf75d22015-01-21 20:39:27 +01002987 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
2988 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002989
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002990 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2991 <name>.
2992
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002993 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2994 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2995 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2996 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2997 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2998 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2999 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3000 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3001
3002 Example:
3003
3004 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3005
3006 applied to:
3007
3008 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3009
3010 outputs:
3011
3012 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3013
3014 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3015
3016 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3017 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3018 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3019 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3020 header.
3021
3022 Example:
3023
3024 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3025
3026 applied to:
3027
3028 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3029
3030 outputs:
3031
3032 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3033
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003034 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3035 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3036 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3037 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3038 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3039 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3040 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3041 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3042
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003043 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3044 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3045 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3046 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3047 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3048 another equipment.
3049
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003050 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3051 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3052 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3053 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3054 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3055 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3056 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3057 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3058
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003059 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3060 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3061 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3062 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3063 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3064 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3065 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3066 admin privileges.
3067
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003068 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3069 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3070 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3071 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3072 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3073 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3074 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3075 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3076
3077 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3078 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3079 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3080 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3081 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3082 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3083
3084 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3085 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3086 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3087 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3088 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3089 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3090
3091 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3092 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3093 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3094 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3095 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3096 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3097 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3098 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3099 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3100
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003101 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3102
3103 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3104 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3105 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3106 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003107
3108 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003109 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3110 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3111 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003112
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003113 http-request allow if nagios
3114 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3115 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3116 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003117
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003118 Example:
3119 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003120 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003121
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003122 Example:
3123 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3124 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3125 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3126 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3127 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3128 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3129 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3130 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3131 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3132
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003133 Example:
3134 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3135 acl add path /addacl
3136 acl del path /delacl
3137
3138 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3139
3140 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3141 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3142
3143 Example:
3144 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3145 acl setmap path /setmap
3146 acl delmap path /delmap
3147
3148 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3149
3150 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3151 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3152
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003153 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3154 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003155
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003156http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003157 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003158 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3159 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003160 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3161 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3162 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3163 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3164 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3165 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003166 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003167 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3168
3169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 no | yes | yes | yes
3171
3172 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3173 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3174 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3175 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3176 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3177 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3178
3179 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3180 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3181 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3182 current section.
3183
3184 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3185 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3186 rules are evaluated.
3187
3188 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3189 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3190 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3191 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3192 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3193 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3194 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3195
3196 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3197 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3198 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3199 external users.
3200
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003201 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3202 <name>.
3203
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003204 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3205 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3206 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3207 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3208 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3209 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3210 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3211 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3212
3213 Example:
3214
3215 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3216
3217 applied to:
3218
3219 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3220
3221 outputs:
3222
3223 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3224
3225 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3226
3227 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3228 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3229 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3230 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3231 header.
3232
3233 Example:
3234
3235 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3236
3237 applied to:
3238
3239 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3240
3241 outputs:
3242
3243 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3244
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003245 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3246 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3247 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3248 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3249 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3250 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3251 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3252 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3253
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003254 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3255 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3256 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3257 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3258 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3259 another equipment.
3260
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003261 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3262 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3263 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3264 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3265 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3266 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3267 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3268 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3269
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003270 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3271 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3272 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3273 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3274 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3275 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3276 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3277 admin privileges.
3278
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003279 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3280 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3281 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3282 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3283 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3284 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3285 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3286 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3287
3288 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3289 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3290 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3291 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3292 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3293 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3294
3295 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3296 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3297 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3298 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3299 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3300 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3301
3302 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3303 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3304 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3305 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3306 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3307 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3308 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3309 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3310 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3311
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003312 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3313
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003314 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003315 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3316 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3317 rules.
3318
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003319 Example:
3320 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3321
3322 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3323
3324 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3325 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3326
3327 Example:
3328 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3329
3330 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3331
3332 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3333 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3334
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003335 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3336 ACL usage.
3337
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003338
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003339http-send-name-header [<header>]
3340 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3341
3342 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3343 yes | no | yes | yes
3344
3345 Arguments :
3346
3347 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3348
3349 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3350 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3351 is added with the header string proved.
3352
3353 See also : "server"
3354
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003355id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003356 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3358 no | yes | yes | yes
3359 Arguments : none
3360
3361 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3362 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3363 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003364
3365
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003366ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3367 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3368 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 no | yes | yes | yes
3370
3371 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3372 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3373 and running).
3374
3375 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3376 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3377 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003378 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003379 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3380
3381 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3382 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3383
3384 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3385 "unless" condition is met.
3386
3387 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3388
3389
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003390log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003391log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003392no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003393 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3395 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003396
3397 Prefix :
3398 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3399 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3400 prefix does not allow arguments.
3401
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003402 Arguments :
3403 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3404 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3405 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3406 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3407 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3408 parameter.
3409
3410 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3411 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3412
3413 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3414 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3415 standard syslog port).
3416
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003417 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3418 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3419 standard syslog port).
3420
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003421 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3422 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3423 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3424 appropriately writeable).
3425
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003426 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3427 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3428 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3429 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3430
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003431 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3432 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3433 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3434 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3435 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3436 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3437 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3438 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3439 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3440 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3441 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3442
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003443 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3444
3445 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3446 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3447 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3448
3449 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3450 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3451 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003452 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3453 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3454 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3455 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3456 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003457
3458 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3459
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003460 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3461 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3462 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003463
3464 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3465 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3466 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3467 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3468
3469 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3470 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003471
3472 Example :
3473 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003474 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3475 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003476 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3477
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003478
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003479log-format <string>
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003480 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3481 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3482 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003483
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003484 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3485 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3486 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3487 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3488 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003489
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003491max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3492 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3494 yes | no | yes | yes
3495
3496 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3497 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3498 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3499 servers.
3500
3501 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3502 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3503 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3504 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3505 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3506 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3507 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3508 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3509 picking a different server.
3510
3511 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3512 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3513 even if they have to be queued.
3514
3515 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3516 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3517
3518
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003519maxconn <conns>
3520 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3522 yes | yes | yes | no
3523 Arguments :
3524 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3525 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3526 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3527 closes.
3528
3529 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3530 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3531 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3532 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3533 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3534 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3535 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3536 properly tuned.
3537
3538 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3539 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3540 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3541
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003542 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3543
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003544 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3545
3546
3547mode { tcp|http|health }
3548 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3550 yes | yes | yes | yes
3551 Arguments :
3552 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3553 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3554 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3555 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3556
3557 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3558 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3559 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3560 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3561 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3562
3563 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003564 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3565 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3566 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3567 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3568 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3569 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3570 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003571
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003572 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3573 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3574 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003575
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003576 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003577 defaults http_instances
3578 mode http
3579
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003580 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003582
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003583monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3586 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003587 Arguments :
3588 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3589 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003590 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3592 backend and its backup.
3593
3594 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3595 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3596 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3597 servers in a list of backends.
3598
3599 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3600 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3601 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3602 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3603 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3604 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3605 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003606 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3607 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003608
3609 Example:
3610 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3613 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3614 monitor-uri /site_alive
3615 monitor fail if site_dead
3616
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003617 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003618
3619
3620monitor-net <source>
3621 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3623 yes | yes | yes | no
3624 Arguments :
3625 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3626 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3627 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3628 followed by a mask.
3629
3630 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3631 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003632 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003633 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3634
3635 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3636 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3637 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3638 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003639 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3640 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3641 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003642
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003643 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3644 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3645 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3646 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3647 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3648 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003649
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003650 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3651 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653 Example :
3654 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3655 frontend www
3656 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3657
3658 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3659
3660
3661monitor-uri <uri>
3662 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3664 yes | yes | yes | no
3665 Arguments :
3666 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3667 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3668
3669 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3670 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3671 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3672 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3673 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3674 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3675 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3676 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3677
3678 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3679 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3680 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3681 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3682 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3683 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3684
3685 Example :
3686 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3687 frontend www
3688 mode http
3689 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3690
3691 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3692
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003693
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003694option abortonclose
3695no option abortonclose
3696 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3698 yes | no | yes | yes
3699 Arguments : none
3700
3701 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3702 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3703 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3704 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003705 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003706 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3707 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3708 encountered while delivering the response.
3709
3710 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3711 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3712 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3713 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3714 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3715 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003716 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003717 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003718 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003719 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3720 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3721 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3722
3723 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3724 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3725 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3726 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3727 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3728 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3729 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3730 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003731 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003732
3733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3735
3736 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3737
3738
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003739option accept-invalid-http-request
3740no option accept-invalid-http-request
3741 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3743 yes | yes | yes | no
3744 Arguments : none
3745
3746 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3747 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3748 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3749 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3750 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3751 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3752 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3753 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003754 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3755 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3756 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3757 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3758 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3759 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003760
3761 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3762 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3763 been confirmed.
3764
3765 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3766 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003767 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3768 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003769 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3770
3771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3773
3774 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3775 stats socket.
3776
3777
3778option accept-invalid-http-response
3779no option accept-invalid-http-response
3780 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | no | yes | yes
3783 Arguments : none
3784
3785 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3786 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3787 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3788 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3789 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3790 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3791 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3792 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3793 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3794
3795 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3796 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3797 been confirmed.
3798
3799 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3800 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3801 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3802 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3803
3804 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3805 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3806
3807 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3808 stats socket.
3809
3810
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003811option allbackups
3812no option allbackups
3813 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3815 yes | no | yes | yes
3816 Arguments : none
3817
3818 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3819 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3820 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3821 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3822 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3823 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3824 order between the backup servers anymore.
3825
3826 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3827 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3828
3829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3831
3832
3833option checkcache
3834no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003835 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3837 yes | no | yes | yes
3838 Arguments : none
3839
3840 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3841 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003842 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003843 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3844 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003845 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003846
3847 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003848 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003849 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003850 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3851 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003852 to the client are :
3853 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003854 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003855 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003856 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3857 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3858 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3859 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3860 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3861 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3862 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3863 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3864 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3865 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3866 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3867
3868 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003869 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003870 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003871 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003872 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3873
3874 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3875 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003876 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003877 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3878
3879 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3880 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3881
3882
3883option clitcpka
3884no option clitcpka
3885 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3887 yes | yes | yes | no
3888 Arguments : none
3889
3890 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3891 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3892 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3893 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3894
3895 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3896 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3897 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3898 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3899
3900 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3901 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3902 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3903 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3904 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3905
3906 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3907
3908 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3909 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3910 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3911
3912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3914
3915 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3916
3917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003918option contstats
3919 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3921 yes | yes | yes | no
3922 Arguments : none
3923
3924 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3925 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3926 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3927 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3928 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3929 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3930 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3931
3932
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003933option dontlog-normal
3934no option dontlog-normal
3935 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3937 yes | yes | yes | no
3938 Arguments : none
3939
3940 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3941 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3942 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3943 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3944 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3945 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3946 logged.
3947
3948 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3949 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3950 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003952 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003953 logging.
3954
3955
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003956option dontlognull
3957no option dontlognull
3958 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 yes | yes | yes | no
3961 Arguments : none
3962
3963 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3964 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3965 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3966 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3967 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3968 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3969 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3970
3971 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3972 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3973 would not be logged.
3974
3975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003978 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003979
3980
3981option forceclose
3982no option forceclose
3983 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003985 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003986 Arguments : none
3987
3988 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3989 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3990 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3991 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3992 global session times in the logs.
3993
3994 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003995 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003996 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003997
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003998 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3999 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4000 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4001
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004002 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4003 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004004
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004005 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4006 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4007
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004008 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004009
4010
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004011option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004012 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4014 yes | yes | yes | yes
4015 Arguments :
4016 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4017 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004018 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004019 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004020
4021 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4022 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4023 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4024 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4025 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4026 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4027 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004028 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4029 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4030 possible that the client has already brought one.
4031
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004032 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004033 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004034 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4035 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004036 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4037 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004038
4039 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4040 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4041 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4042 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4043 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4044 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4045 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4046
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004047 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4048 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4049 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4050 are under the control of the end-user.
4051
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004052 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004053 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4054 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004055 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4056 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4057 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004058
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004059 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004060 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4061 frontend www
4062 mode http
4063 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4064
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004065 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4066 backend www
4067 mode http
4068 option forwardfor header X-Client
4069
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004070 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004071 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004072
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004073
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004074option http-keep-alive
4075no option http-keep-alive
4076 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4078 yes | yes | yes | yes
4079 Arguments : none
4080
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004081 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4082 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4083 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4084 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4085 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4086 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4087 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4088
4089 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4090 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004091 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4092 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4093 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4094 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4095 situations where this option may be useful :
4096
4097 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4098 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4099
4100 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4101 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4102
4103 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4104 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4105 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4106 request.
4107
4108 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4109 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004110 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4111 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4112 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004113
4114 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4115 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4116
4117 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4118 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4119 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4120 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4121 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4122 not set.
4123
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004124 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4125 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004126 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004127 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004128
4129 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004130 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4131 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004132
4133
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004134option http-no-delay
4135no option http-no-delay
4136 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4138 yes | yes | yes | yes
4139 Arguments : none
4140
4141 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4142 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4143 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4144 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4145 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4146 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4147 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4148 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4149 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4150 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4151 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4152 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4153 affected.
4154
4155 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4156 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4157 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4158 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4159 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4160 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4161 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4162 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4163 latency environments.
4164
4165
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004166option http-pretend-keepalive
4167no option http-pretend-keepalive
4168 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | yes | yes | yes
4171 Arguments : none
4172
4173 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4174 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4175 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4176 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4177 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4178 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4179 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4180 consider the response complete.
4181
4182 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4183 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4184 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4185 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4186 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4187 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4188
4189 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4190 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4191 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4192 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4193 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4194 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4195 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4196
4197 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4198 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004199 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004200 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4201 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004202
4203 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4204 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4205
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004206 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4207 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004208
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004209
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004210option http-server-close
4211no option http-server-close
4212 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4214 yes | yes | yes | yes
4215 Arguments : none
4216
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004217 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4218 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4219 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4220 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4221 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4222 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4223 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4224 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4225 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4226 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4227 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4228 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4229 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4230 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4231 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4232 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004233
4234 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4235 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4236 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4237 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004238 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4239 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004240
4241 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4242 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004243 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4244 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004245 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4246 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004247
4248 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4249 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4250
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004251 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004252 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4253 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004254
4255
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004256option http-tunnel
4257no option http-tunnel
4258 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4260 yes | yes | yes | yes
4261 Arguments : none
4262
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004263 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4264 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4265 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4266 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4267 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4268 "option http-tunnel".
4269
4270 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004271 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004272 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4273 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4274 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4275 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4276 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4277 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4278 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004279
4280 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4281 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4282
4283 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4284 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4285 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4286
4287
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004288option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004289no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004290 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4292 yes | yes | yes | no
4293 Arguments : none
4294
4295 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4296 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4297 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4298 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4299 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4300 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4301 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4302
4303 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4304 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4305 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4306 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4307 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4308 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4309 request along its whole life.
4310
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004311 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4312 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4313 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4314 front of an existing proxy.
4315
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004316 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4317
4318 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4319 http-server-close".
4320
4321
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004322option httpchk
4323option httpchk <uri>
4324option httpchk <method> <uri>
4325option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4326 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 yes | no | yes | yes
4329 Arguments :
4330 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4331 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4332 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4333 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4334 ones.
4335
4336 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4337 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4338 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4339
4340 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4341 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4342 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4343 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4344 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4345
4346 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4347 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4348 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4349 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4350 the lack of any response.
4351
4352 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4353
4354 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4355 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4356 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4357
4358 Examples :
4359 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4360 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4361 backend https_relay
4362 mode tcp
4363 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4364 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4365
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004366 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4367 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4368 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004369
4370
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004371option httpclose
4372no option httpclose
4373 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4375 yes | yes | yes | yes
4376 Arguments : none
4377
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004378 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4379 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4380 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4381 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004382 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004383 "option http-tunnel".
4384
4385 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4386 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4387 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4388 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4389 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4390 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4391 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4392 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004393
4394 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004395 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004396 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4397 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4398 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4399 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4400 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004401
4402 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4403 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004404 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4405 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004406 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4407 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004408
4409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4411
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004412 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4413 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004414
4415
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004416option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004417 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4419 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004420 Arguments :
4421 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4422 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4423 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4424 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4425 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004426
4427 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4428 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4429 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4430 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4431 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4432 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4433 ports.
4434
4435 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4436
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004437 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4438 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004440 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004441
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004442
4443option http_proxy
4444no option http_proxy
4445 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4447 yes | yes | yes | yes
4448 Arguments : none
4449
4450 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4451 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4452 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4453 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4454 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4455
4456 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4457 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4458 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4459 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004460 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004461 be analyzed.
4462
4463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4465
4466 Example :
4467 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4468 backend direct_forward
4469 option httpclose
4470 option http_proxy
4471
4472 See also : "option httpclose"
4473
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004474
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004475option independent-streams
4476no option independent-streams
4477 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | yes | yes | yes
4480 Arguments : none
4481
4482 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4483 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4484 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4485 receive data or not.
4486
4487 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4488 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4489 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4490 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4491 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4492 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4493 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4494 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4495 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4496 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4497 socket buffers.
4498
4499 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4500 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4501 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4502 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4503 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4504
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004505 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004506 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4507 deprecated.
4508
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004509 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004510
4511
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004512option ldap-check
4513 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 yes | no | yes | yes
4516 Arguments : none
4517
4518 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4519 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4520 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4521 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4522
4523 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4524 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4525
4526 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4527 configure it.
4528
4529 Example :
4530 option ldap-check
4531
4532 See also : "option httpchk"
4533
4534
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004535option log-health-checks
4536no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004537 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4539 yes | no | yes | yes
4540 Arguments : none
4541
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004542 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4543 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4544 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004545
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004546 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4547 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4548 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4549 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4550 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4551
4552 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4553 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004554
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004555 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4556 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4557 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004558
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004559
4560option log-separate-errors
4561no option log-separate-errors
4562 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4564 yes | yes | yes | no
4565 Arguments : none
4566
4567 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4568 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4569 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4570 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4571 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4572 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4573 provides very important information.
4574
4575 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4576 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4577 error logs.
4578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004579 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004580 logging.
4581
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004582
4583option logasap
4584no option logasap
4585 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4587 yes | yes | yes | no
4588 Arguments : none
4589
4590 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4591 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4592 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4593 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4594 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4595 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4596 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004597 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004598 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4599 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4600
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004601 Examples :
4602 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4603 mode http
4604 option httplog
4605 option logasap
4606 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4607
4608 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4609 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4610 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4611 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004613 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004614 logging.
4615
4616
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004617option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004618 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004621 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004622 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4623 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004624 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004625
4626 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4627 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4628 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4629 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4630 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4631 in the MySQL table, like this :
4632
4633 USE mysql;
4634 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4635 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4636
4637 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4638 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4639 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4640 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4641 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4642 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4643 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4644 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4645 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4646
4647 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4648 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004649
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004650 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004651
4652 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4653 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4654 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4655 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4656 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4657 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4658
4659 See also: "option httpchk"
4660
4661
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004662option nolinger
4663no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004664 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4666 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004667 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004668
4669 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4670 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4671 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4672 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4673 connections.
4674
4675 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4676 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4677 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4678 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4679 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4680 this too.
4681
4682 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4683 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4684 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4685
4686 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4687 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4688 for servers.
4689
4690 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4691 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4692
4693
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004694option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4695 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4697 yes | yes | yes | yes
4698 Arguments :
4699 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4700 matching <network>
4701 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4702 header name.
4703
4704 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4705 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4706 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4707 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4708 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4709 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4710 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4711 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4712 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4713 possible that the client has already brought one.
4714
4715 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4716 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4717 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4718 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4719 header and requires different one.
4720
4721 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4722 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4723 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4724 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4725 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4726 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4727 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4728
4729 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4730 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4731 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4732 both are defined.
4733
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004734 Examples :
4735 # Original Destination address
4736 frontend www
4737 mode http
4738 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4739
4740 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4741 backend www
4742 mode http
4743 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4744
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004745 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4746 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004747
4748
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004749option persist
4750no option persist
4751 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4752 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4753 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004754 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004755
4756 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4757 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4758 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4759 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4760 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4761 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4762 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4763 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4764 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4765 redirected to another valid server.
4766
4767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4769
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004770 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004771
4772
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004773option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4774 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4776 yes | no | yes | yes
4777 Arguments :
4778 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4779 PostgreSQL server.
4780
4781 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4782 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4783 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4784 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4785
4786 See also: "option httpchk"
4787
4788
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004789option prefer-last-server
4790no option prefer-last-server
4791 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | no | yes | yes
4794 Arguments : none
4795
4796 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4797 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4798 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4799 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4800 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4801 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4802 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4803 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4804 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004805 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4806 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4807 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4808 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4809 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4810 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4811 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004812
4813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4815
4816 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4817
4818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004819option redispatch
4820no option redispatch
4821 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4822 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4823 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004824 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004825
4826 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4827 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4828 be able to access the service anymore.
4829
4830 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4831 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4832
4833 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4834 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4835 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004837 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4838 "redisp" keywords.
4839
4840 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4841 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4842
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004843 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004844
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004845
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004846option redis-check
4847 Use redis health checks for server testing
4848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4849 yes | no | yes | yes
4850 Arguments : none
4851
4852 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4853 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4854 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4855 find the "+PONG" response message.
4856
4857 Example :
4858 option redis-check
4859
4860 See also : "option httpchk"
4861
4862
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004863option smtpchk
4864option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4865 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4867 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004868 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004869 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4870 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4871 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4872
4873 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4874 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4875 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4876
4877 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4878 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4879 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4880 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4881 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4882 dead server.
4883
4884 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4885 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4886 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4887 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4888
4889 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4890 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4891 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4892 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4893 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4894
4895 Example :
4896 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4897
4898 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004901option socket-stats
4902no option socket-stats
4903
4904 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | yes | yes | no
4907
4908 Arguments : none
4909
4910
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004911option splice-auto
4912no option splice-auto
4913 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | yes
4916 Arguments : none
4917
4918 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4919 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4920 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4921 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004922 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004923 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4924 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4925 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4926 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4927
4928 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4929 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4930 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4931 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4932 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4933 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4934 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4935 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4936 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4937 keyword.
4938
4939 Example :
4940 option splice-auto
4941
4942 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4943 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4944
4945 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4946 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4947
4948
4949option splice-request
4950no option splice-request
4951 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4953 yes | yes | yes | yes
4954 Arguments : none
4955
4956 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004957 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004958 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4959 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4960 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4961 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4962
4963 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4964
4965 Example :
4966 option splice-request
4967
4968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4970
4971 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4972 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4973
4974
4975option splice-response
4976no option splice-response
4977 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4979 yes | yes | yes | yes
4980 Arguments : none
4981
4982 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004983 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004984 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4985 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4986 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4987 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4988
4989 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4990
4991 Example :
4992 option splice-response
4993
4994 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4995 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4996
4997 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4998 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4999
5000
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005001option srvtcpka
5002no option srvtcpka
5003 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5005 yes | no | yes | yes
5006 Arguments : none
5007
5008 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5009 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5010 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5011 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5012
5013 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5014 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5015 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5016 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5017
5018 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5019 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5020 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5021 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5022 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5023
5024 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5025
5026 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5027 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5028 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5029
5030 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5031 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5032
5033 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5034
5035
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005036option ssl-hello-chk
5037 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | no | yes | yes
5040 Arguments : none
5041
5042 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5043 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5044 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5045 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5046 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5047 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5048 hello message.
5049
5050 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5051 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5052 messages, which is appreciable.
5053
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005054 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5055 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5056 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005057
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005058 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5059
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005060
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005061option tcp-check
5062 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5063 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | no | yes | yes
5065
5066 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5067 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5068
5069 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5070 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5071 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5072
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005073 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005074 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5075 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5076 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5077 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5078 only.
5079
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005080 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005081 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5082 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5083 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5084 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5085
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005086 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005087 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5088 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005089 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005090 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5091 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5092 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5093 the respective protocols.
5094 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5095 analysed.
5096
5097 Examples :
5098 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5099 option tcp-check
5100 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5101
5102 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5103 option tcp-check
5104 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5105
5106 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5107 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005108 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005109 option tcp-check
5110 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5111 tcp-check expect +PONG
5112 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5113 tcp-check expect string role:master
5114 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5115 tcp-check expect string +OK
5116
5117 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5118 (send many headers before analyzing)
5119 option tcp-check
5120 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5121 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5122 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5123 tcp-check send \r\n
5124 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5125
5126
5127 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5128
5129
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005130option tcp-smart-accept
5131no option tcp-smart-accept
5132 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5134 yes | yes | yes | no
5135 Arguments : none
5136
5137 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5138 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5139 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5140 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5141 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5142 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5143
5144 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5145 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5146 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5147 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5148
5149 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5150 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5151 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5152 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5153
5154 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5155 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5156 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5157
5158 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5159 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5160 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5161
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005162 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5163
5164
5165option tcp-smart-connect
5166no option tcp-smart-connect
5167 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | yes | yes
5170 Arguments : none
5171
5172 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5173 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5174 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5175 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5176 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5177
5178 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5179 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5180 complex.
5181
5182 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5183 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5184 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5185
5186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5188
5189 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5190
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005191
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005192option tcpka
5193 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | yes | yes | yes
5196 Arguments : none
5197
5198 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5199 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5200 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5201 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5202
5203 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5204 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5205 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5206 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5207
5208 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5209 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5210 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5211 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5212 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5213
5214 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5215
5216 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5217 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5218 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5219 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5220 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5221 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5222 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5223 backends.
5224
5225 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5226
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005227
5228option tcplog
5229 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5231 yes | yes | yes | yes
5232 Arguments : none
5233
5234 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5235 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5236 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5237 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5238 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5239 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5240 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5241 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5242
5243 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005245 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005246
5247
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005248option transparent
5249no option transparent
5250 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005252 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005253 Arguments : none
5254
5255 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5256 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5257 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5258 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5259 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5260 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5261 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5262 appropriate server.
5263
5264 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5265 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5266
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005267 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005268 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005269
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005270
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005271persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005272persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005273 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5275 yes | no | yes | yes
5276 Arguments :
5277 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005278 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5279 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005280
5281 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5282 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5283 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5284 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5285 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5286 forwarded to this server.
5287
5288 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5289 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5290 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005291 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005292 a single "listen" section.
5293
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005294 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5295 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5296 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5297
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005298 Example :
5299 listen tse-farm
5300 bind :3389
5301 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5302 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5303 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5304 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5305 persist rdp-cookie
5306 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005307 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005308 balance rdp-cookie
5309 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5310 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5311
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005312 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5313 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005314
5315
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005316rate-limit sessions <rate>
5317 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | yes | yes | no
5320 Arguments :
5321 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5322 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5323
5324 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5325 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5326 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5327 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5328 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5329 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5330
5331 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5332 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5333 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5334 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5335
5336 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5337 listen smtp
5338 mode tcp
5339 bind :25
5340 rate-limit sessions 10
5341 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5342
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005343 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5344 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5345 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005346
5347 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5348
5349
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005350redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5351redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5352redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005353 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 no | yes | yes | yes
5356
5357 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005358 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005359
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005360 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005361 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005362 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5363 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5364 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005365
5366 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5367 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5368 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5369 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5370 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005371 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5372 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5373 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5374 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005375
5376 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5377 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5378 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5379 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5380 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5381 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005382 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005383 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005384 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5385 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5386 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005387
5388 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005389 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5390 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5391 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5392 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5393 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5394 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5395 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5396 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005397
5398 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5399 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5400
5401 - "drop-query"
5402 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5403 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5404 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5405 with a location-type redirect.
5406
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005407 - "append-slash"
5408 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5409 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5410 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5411 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5412
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005413 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5414 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5415 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5416 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5417 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5418 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5419 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5420
5421 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5422 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5423 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5424 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5425 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5426 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5427 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005428
5429 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5430 acl clear dst_port 80
5431 acl secure dst_port 8080
5432 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005433 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005434 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005435 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5436
5437 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005438 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5439 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5440 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005441 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005442
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005443 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5444 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5445 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5446
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005447 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005448 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005449
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005450 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5451 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5452 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005454 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005455
5456
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005457redisp (deprecated)
5458redispatch (deprecated)
5459 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5461 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005462 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005463
5464 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5465 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5466 be able to access the service anymore.
5467
5468 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5469 redistribute them to a working server.
5470
5471 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5472 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5473 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005475 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5476 "option redispatch" instead.
5477
5478 See also : "option redispatch"
5479
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005480
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005481reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005482 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5484 no | yes | yes | yes
5485 Arguments :
5486 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5487 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005488 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005489
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005490 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5491 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5492
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005493 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5494 the last header of an HTTP request.
5495
5496 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5497 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5498 responses.
5499
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005500 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5501 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5502 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5503
5504 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5505 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005506
5507
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005508reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5509reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005510 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5512 no | yes | yes | yes
5513 Arguments :
5514 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5515 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5516 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5517 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5518 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5519 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5520 ignores case.
5521
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005522 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5523 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5524
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005525 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5526 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5527 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5528 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005529 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005530
5531 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5532 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5533
5534 Example :
5535 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5536 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5537 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005539 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5540 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005541
5542
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005543reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5544reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005545 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5547 no | yes | yes | yes
5548 Arguments :
5549 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5550 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5551 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5552 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5553 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5554 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5555
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005556 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5557 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5558
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005559 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5560 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5561 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5562 next servers.
5563
5564 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5565 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5566 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5567
5568 Example :
5569 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5570 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5571 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5572
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005573 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5574 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005575
5576
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005577reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5578reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005579 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5581 no | yes | yes | yes
5582 Arguments :
5583 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5584 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5585 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5586 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5587 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5588 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5589 case.
5590
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005591 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5592 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5593
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005594 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5595 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5596 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5597 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005598 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005599
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005600 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005601 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005602 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005603
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005604 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5605 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5606
5607 Example :
5608 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5609 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5610 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5611
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005612 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5613 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005614
5615
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005616reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5617reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005618 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5620 no | yes | yes | yes
5621 Arguments :
5622 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5623 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5624 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5625 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5626 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5627 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5628 case.
5629
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005630 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5631 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5632
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005633 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5634 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5635 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5636 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5637
5638 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5639 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5640
5641 Example :
5642 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5643 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5644 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5645 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5646
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005647 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5648 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005649
5650
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005651reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5652reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005653 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5655 no | yes | yes | yes
5656 Arguments :
5657 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5658 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5659 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5660 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5661 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5662 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5663
5664 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5665 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5666 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5667 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005668 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005669
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005670 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5671 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5672
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005673 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5674 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5675 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5676
5677 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5678 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5679 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5680 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5681 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5682
5683 Example :
5684 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005685 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005686 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5687 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5688
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005689 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5690 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005691
5692
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005693reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5694reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005695 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5697 no | yes | yes | yes
5698 Arguments :
5699 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5700 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5701 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5702 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5703 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5704 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5705 ignores case.
5706
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005707 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5708 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5709
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005710 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5711 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005712 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5713 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5714 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005715 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5716 not set.
5717
5718 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5719 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5720 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5721 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5722 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5723
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005724 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005725 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5726 # block all others.
5727 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5728 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5729
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005730 # block bad guys
5731 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5732 reqitarpit . if badguys
5733
5734 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5735 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005736
5737
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005738retries <value>
5739 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5741 yes | no | yes | yes
5742 Arguments :
5743 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5744 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5745 default value is 3.
5746
5747 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5748 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5749 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5750
5751 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5752 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5753
5754 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5755 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5756
5757 See also : "option redispatch"
5758
5759
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005760rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005761 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5763 no | yes | yes | yes
5764 Arguments :
5765 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5766 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005767 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005768
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005769 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5770 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5771
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005772 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5773 the last header of an HTTP response.
5774
5775 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5776 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5777 responses.
5778
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005779 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5780 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005781
5782
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005783rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5784rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005785 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5787 no | yes | yes | yes
5788 Arguments :
5789 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5790 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5791 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5792 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5793 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5794 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5795 ignores case.
5796
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005797 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5798 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5799
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005800 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5801 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005802 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005803 client.
5804
5805 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5806 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5807 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5808
5809 Example :
5810 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005811 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005812
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005813 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5814 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005815
5816
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005817rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5818rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005819 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5821 no | yes | yes | yes
5822 Arguments :
5823 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5824 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5825 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5826 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5827 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5828 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5829 ignores case.
5830
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005831 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5832 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5833
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005834 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5835 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5836 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5837 case-sensitive.
5838
5839 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005840 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5841 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5842 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005843
5844 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5845 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5846
5847 Example :
5848 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5849 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5850
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005851 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5852 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005853
5854
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005855rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5856rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005857 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5859 no | yes | yes | yes
5860 Arguments :
5861 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5862 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5863 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5864 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5865 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5866 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5867 ignores case.
5868
5869 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5870 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5871 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5872 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005873 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005874
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005875 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5876 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5877
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005878 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5879 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5880 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5881
5882 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5883 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5884 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5885 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5886 are not case-sensitive.
5887
5888 Example :
5889 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5890 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5891
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005892 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5893 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005894
5895
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005896server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005897 Declare a server in a backend
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 no | no | yes | yes
5900 Arguments :
5901 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005902 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005903 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005904
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005905 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5906 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5907 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5908 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005909 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5910 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5911 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5912 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5913 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005914 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5915 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5916 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5917 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5918 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5919 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5920 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005921 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005922 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5923 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5924 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5925 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005926
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005927 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005928 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5929 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5930 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5931 adding this value to the client's port.
5932
5933 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5934 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005935 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005936
5937 Examples :
5938 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5939 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005940 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005941 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5942 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5943 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005944
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005945 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5946 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005947
5948
5949source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005950source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005951source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005952 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5954 yes | no | yes | yes
5955 Arguments :
5956 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5957 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005958
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005959 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005960 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5961 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5962 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5963 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5964 supported prefixes are :
5965 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5966 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5967 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005968 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005969 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5970 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5971 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5972 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005973
5974 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5975 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005976 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5977 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5978 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005979
5980 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5981 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5982 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5983 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5984 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5985 <addr>.
5986
5987 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5988 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5989 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5990 port.
5991
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005992 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5993 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5994 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5995 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005996 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005997 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5998 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5999 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6000 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6001 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6002 HTTP header.
6003
6004 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6005 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006006 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006007 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6008 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6009 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6010 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6011 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6012 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6013 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6014
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006015 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6016 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6017 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6018 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6019 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6020 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6021
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006022 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6023 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6024 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6025 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6026
6027 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6028 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6029 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6030 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6031 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6032 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6033
6034 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6035 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6036 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6037 there are two methods :
6038
6039 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6040 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6041 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6042 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6043 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6044 of the client ranges may be used.
6045
6046 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6047 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6048 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6049 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6050 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6051 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6052 same session.
6053
6054 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6055 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6056 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6057 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6058 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6059 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6060
6061 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6062 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6063 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006064 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006065
6066 Examples :
6067 backend private
6068 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6069 source 192.168.1.200
6070
6071 backend transparent_ssl1
6072 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6073 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6074
6075 backend transparent_ssl2
6076 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6077 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6078 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6079
6080 backend transparent_ssl3
6081 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6082 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6083 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6084
6085 backend transparent_smtp
6086 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6087 # with Tproxy version 4.
6088 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6089
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006090 backend transparent_http
6091 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6092 # proxy.
6093 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006095 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006096 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006098
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006099srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6100 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6102 yes | no | yes | yes
6103 Arguments :
6104 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6105 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6106 as explained at the top of this document.
6107
6108 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6109 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6110 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6111 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6112 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6113 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6114 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6115
6116 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6117 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6118 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6119 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6120 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006121 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006122 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006123 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006124
6125 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6126 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6127 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6128 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6129 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6130 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6131
6132 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6133 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6134
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006135 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6136 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006137
6138
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006139stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6140 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006142 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006143
6144 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6145 matched.
6146
6147 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6148 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6149
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006150 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6151 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6152 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6153
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006154 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6155 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6156 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6157 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006158
6159 Example :
6160 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6161 backend stats_localhost
6162 stats enable
6163 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6164
6165 Example :
6166 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6167 backend stats_auth
6168 stats enable
6169 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6170 stats admin if TRUE
6171
6172 Example :
6173 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6174 userlist stats-auth
6175 group admin users admin
6176 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6177 group readonly users haproxy
6178 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6179
6180 backend stats_auth
6181 stats enable
6182 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6183 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6184 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6185 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6186
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006187 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6188 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6189 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006190
6191
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006192stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6193 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006195 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006196 Arguments :
6197 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6198
6199 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6200
6201 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6202 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6203 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6204 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6205 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6206 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6207
6208 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6209 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6210 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006211 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006212
6213 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6214 report using "stats scope".
6215
6216 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6217 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6218 unobvious parameters.
6219
6220 Example :
6221 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6222 backend public_www
6223 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6224 stats enable
6225 stats hide-version
6226 stats scope .
6227 stats uri /admin?stats
6228 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6229 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6230 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6231
6232 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6233 backend private_monitoring
6234 stats enable
6235 stats uri /admin?stats
6236 stats refresh 5s
6237
6238 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6239
6240
6241stats enable
6242 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006244 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006245 Arguments : none
6246
6247 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6248 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6249 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6250 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6251 - stats auth : no authentication
6252 - stats scope : no restriction
6253
6254 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6255 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6256 unobvious parameters.
6257
6258 Example :
6259 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6260 backend public_www
6261 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6262 stats enable
6263 stats hide-version
6264 stats scope .
6265 stats uri /admin?stats
6266 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6267 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6268 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6269
6270 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6271 backend private_monitoring
6272 stats enable
6273 stats uri /admin?stats
6274 stats refresh 5s
6275
6276 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6277
6278
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006279stats hide-version
6280 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006282 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006283 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006284
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006285 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6286 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6287 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6288 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6289 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6290 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006292 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6293 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6294 unobvious parameters.
6295
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006296 Example :
6297 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6298 backend public_www
6299 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006300 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006301 stats hide-version
6302 stats scope .
6303 stats uri /admin?stats
6304 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6305 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6306 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006307
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006308 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6309 backend private_monitoring
6310 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006311 stats uri /admin?stats
6312 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006313
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006314 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006315
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006316
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006317stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6318 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6319 Access control for statistics
6320
6321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6322 no | no | yes | yes
6323
6324 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6325 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6326 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6327 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6328 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6329 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6330
6331 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6332 instance.
6333
6334 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6335 about ACL usage.
6336
6337
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006338stats realm <realm>
6339 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006341 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006342 Arguments :
6343 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6344 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6345 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6346
6347 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6348 using a backslash ('\').
6349
6350 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6351 only related to authentication.
6352
6353 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6354 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6355 unobvious parameters.
6356
6357 Example :
6358 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6359 backend public_www
6360 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6361 stats enable
6362 stats hide-version
6363 stats scope .
6364 stats uri /admin?stats
6365 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6366 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6367 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6368
6369 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6370 backend private_monitoring
6371 stats enable
6372 stats uri /admin?stats
6373 stats refresh 5s
6374
6375 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6376
6377
6378stats refresh <delay>
6379 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006381 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006382 Arguments :
6383 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6384 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6385 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6386 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6387 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6388 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6389
6390 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6391 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6392 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6393 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6394
6395 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6396 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6397 unobvious parameters.
6398
6399 Example :
6400 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6401 backend public_www
6402 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6403 stats enable
6404 stats hide-version
6405 stats scope .
6406 stats uri /admin?stats
6407 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6408 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6409 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6410
6411 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6412 backend private_monitoring
6413 stats enable
6414 stats uri /admin?stats
6415 stats refresh 5s
6416
6417 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6418
6419
6420stats scope { <name> | "." }
6421 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006423 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006424 Arguments :
6425 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6426 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6427 section in which the statement appears.
6428
6429 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6430 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6431 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6432 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6433 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6434 exists.
6435
6436 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6437 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6438 unobvious parameters.
6439
6440 Example :
6441 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6442 backend public_www
6443 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6444 stats enable
6445 stats hide-version
6446 stats scope .
6447 stats uri /admin?stats
6448 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6449 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6450 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6451
6452 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6453 backend private_monitoring
6454 stats enable
6455 stats uri /admin?stats
6456 stats refresh 5s
6457
6458 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6459
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006460
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006461stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006462 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006464 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006465
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006466 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006467 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6468
6469 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6470 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6471
6472 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6473 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006474 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006475
6476 Example :
6477 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6478 backend private_monitoring
6479 stats enable
6480 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6481 stats uri /admin?stats
6482 stats refresh 5s
6483
6484 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6485 global section.
6486
6487
6488stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006489 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6491 yes | yes | yes | yes
6492 Arguments : none
6493
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006494 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006495 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6496 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6497 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6498 - IP (socket, server)
6499 - cookie (backend, server)
6500
6501 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6502 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006503 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006504
6505 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6506
6507
6508stats show-node [ <name> ]
6509 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006511 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006512 Arguments:
6513 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6514 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6515
6516 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6517 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006518 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006519
6520 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6521 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6522 unobvious parameters.
6523
6524 Example:
6525 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6526 backend private_monitoring
6527 stats enable
6528 stats show-node Europe-1
6529 stats uri /admin?stats
6530 stats refresh 5s
6531
6532 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6533 section.
6534
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006535
6536stats uri <prefix>
6537 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006539 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006540 Arguments :
6541 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6542 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6543 query string.
6544
6545 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6546 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6547 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6548 possible to reach it in the application.
6549
6550 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006551 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006552 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6553 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6554 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6555 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6556
6557 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6558 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6559 an address or a port to statistics only.
6560
6561 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6562 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6563 unobvious parameters.
6564
6565 Example :
6566 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6567 backend public_www
6568 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6569 stats enable
6570 stats hide-version
6571 stats scope .
6572 stats uri /admin?stats
6573 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6574 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6575 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6576
6577 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6578 backend private_monitoring
6579 stats enable
6580 stats uri /admin?stats
6581 stats refresh 5s
6582
6583 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6584
6585
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006586stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6587 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006589 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006590
6591 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006592 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006593 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6594 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6595 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6596
6597 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6598 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6599 the "stick-table" statement.
6600
6601 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6602 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6603 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6604 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6605 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6606
6607 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6608 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6609 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6610 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6611 transformation rules.
6612
6613 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6614 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6615 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6616 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6617 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6618 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6619 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6620
6621 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6622 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6623 ACL based conditions.
6624
6625 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6626 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6627 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6628 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6629
6630 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6631 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6632 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6633 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6634
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006635 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6636 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6637 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6638
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006639 Example :
6640 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6641 # last 30 minutes
6642 backend pop
6643 mode tcp
6644 balance roundrobin
6645 stick store-request src
6646 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6647 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6648 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6649
6650 backend smtp
6651 mode tcp
6652 balance roundrobin
6653 stick match src table pop
6654 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6655 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6656
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006657 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006658 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006659
6660
6661stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6662 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6664 no | no | yes | yes
6665
6666 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6667 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6668 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6669 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6670
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006671 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6672 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6673 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6674
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006675 Examples :
6676 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006677 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006678
6679 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6680 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6681 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6682
6683
6684 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6685 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6686 backend http
6687 mode http
6688 balance roundrobin
6689 stick on src table https
6690 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6691 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6692 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6693
6694 backend https
6695 mode tcp
6696 balance roundrobin
6697 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6698 stick on src
6699 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6700 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6701
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006702 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006703
6704
6705stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6706 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6708 no | no | yes | yes
6709
6710 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006711 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006712 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6713 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6714 server is selected.
6715
6716 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6717 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6718 the "stick-table" statement.
6719
6720 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6721 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6722 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6723 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6724 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6725 address.
6726
6727 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6728 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6729 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6730 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6731 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6732 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6733 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6734 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6735 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6736 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6737
6738 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6739 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6740 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6741 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6742 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6743 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6744 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6745
6746 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6747 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6748 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6749 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6750
6751 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6752 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6753 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6754 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6755 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6756 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006757 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6758 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6759 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6760 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6761 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6762 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006763
6764 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6765 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6766 the request.
6767
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006768 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6769 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6770 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6771
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006772 Example :
6773 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6774 # last 30 minutes
6775 backend pop
6776 mode tcp
6777 balance roundrobin
6778 stick store-request src
6779 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6780 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6781 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6782
6783 backend smtp
6784 mode tcp
6785 balance roundrobin
6786 stick match src table pop
6787 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6788 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6789
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006790 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006791 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006792
6793
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006794stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006795 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6796 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006797 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006799 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006800
6801 Arguments :
6802 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6803 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6804 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6805 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6806
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006807 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6808 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6809 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6810 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6811
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006812 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6813 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6814 instance.
6815
6816 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6817 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6818 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6819 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6820 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6821 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006822 to 32 characters.
6823
6824 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6825 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6826 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006827 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006828 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6829 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006830
6831 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006832 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6833 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006834 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6835 increase.
6836
6837 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006838 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6839 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6840 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006841
6842 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6843 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6844 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6845 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6846 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6847 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6848 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6849 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6850 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6851 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6852 parameter (see below).
6853
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006854 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6855 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6856 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6857 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6858 soft restart.
6859
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006860 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6861
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006862 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6863 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6864 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6865 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6866 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006867 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006868 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6869 if not expiration delay is specified.
6870
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006871 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6872 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6873 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6874 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006875 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6876 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6877 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6878 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6879 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6880 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6881 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6882 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6883 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6884 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6885 types and their arguments.
6886
6887 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6888 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6889 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6890 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6891
6892 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6893 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6894 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6895 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6896
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006897 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6898 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6899 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6900 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6901 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6902 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6903
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006904 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6905 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6906 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6907 they were received.
6908
6909 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6910 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6911 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6912 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6913 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6914
6915 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6916 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6917 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6918 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6919 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6920
6921 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6922 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6923 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6924
6925 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6926 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6927 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6928 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6929 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6930
6931 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6932 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6933 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6934 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6935 the client side.
6936
6937 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6938 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6939 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6940 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6941 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6942 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6943 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6944
6945 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6946 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6947 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6948 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6949 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6950 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6951 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6952
6953 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6954 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6955 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6956 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6957 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6958 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6959
6960 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6961 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6962 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6963 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6964
6965 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6966 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6967 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6968 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6969 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6970 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6971 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6972 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6973 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6974 recommended for better fairness.
6975
6976 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6977 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6978 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6979 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6980
6981 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6982 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6983 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6984 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6985 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6986 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6987 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6988 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6989 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6990 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006991
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006992 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6993 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006994 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6995 reference it.
6996
6997 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6998 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6999 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7000 as an exclusive stickiness.
7001
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007002 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7003 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7004 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7005 something that can be ignored.
7006
7007 Example:
7008 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7009 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7010 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7011 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7012
7013 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007014 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007015
7016
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007017stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7018 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7020 no | no | yes | yes
7021
7022 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007023 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007024 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7025 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7026 server is selected.
7027
7028 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7029 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7030 the "stick-table" statement.
7031
7032 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7033 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7034 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7035 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7036
7037 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7038 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7039 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7040 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7041 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7042 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007043 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007044 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7045 rules.
7046
7047 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7048 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7049 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7050 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7051 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7052 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7053 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7054
7055 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7056 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7057 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7058 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7059
7060 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7061 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7062 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7063 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7064 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7065 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007066 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7067 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7068 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7069 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7070 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7071 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7072 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7073 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7074 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007075
7076 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7077
7078 Example :
7079 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7080 backend https
7081 mode tcp
7082 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007083 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007084 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007085
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007086 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7087 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7088
7089 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7090 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7091 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7092
7093 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7094 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007095
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007096 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7097 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7098 # at offset 44.
7099
7100 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7101 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7102
7103 # Learn on response if server hello.
7104 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007105
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007106 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7107 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7108
7109 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7110 extraction.
7111
7112
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007113tcp-check connect [params*]
7114 Opens a new connection
7115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7116 no | no | yes | yes
7117
7118 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7119 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7120 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7121
7122 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7123 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7124 of the sequence.
7125
7126 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7127 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7128 do.
7129
7130 Parameters :
7131 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7132 use the TCP connection.
7133
7134 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7135 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7136 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7137
7138 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7139
7140 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7141
7142 Examples:
7143 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7144 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7145 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7146 option tcp-check
7147 tcp-check connect
7148 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7149 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7150 tcp-check send \r\n
7151 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7152 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7153 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7154 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7155 tcp-check send \r\n
7156 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7157 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7158
7159 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7160 option tcp-check
7161 tcp-check connect port 110
7162 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7163 tcp-check connect port 143
7164 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7165 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7166
7167 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7168
7169
7170tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7171 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7173 no | no | yes | yes
7174
7175 Arguments :
7176 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7177 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7178 binary.
7179 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7180 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7181 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7182
7183 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7184 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7185 with the usual backslash ('\').
7186 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7187 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7188 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7189 used upper or lower case.
7190
7191
7192 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7193
7194 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7195 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7196 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7197 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7198 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7199 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7200 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7201 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7202
7203 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7204 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7205 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7206 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7207 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7208 expression.
7209
7210 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7211 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7212 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7213 this exact hexadecimal string.
7214 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7215
7216 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7217 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7218 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7219 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7220 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7221 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7222 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7223 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7224 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7225 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7226 the null character.
7227
7228 Examples :
7229 # perform a POP check
7230 option tcp-check
7231 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7232
7233 # perform an IMAP check
7234 option tcp-check
7235 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7236
7237 # look for the redis master server
7238 option tcp-check
7239 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7240 tcp-check expect +PONG
7241 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7242 tcp-check expect string role:master
7243 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7244 tcp-check expect string +OK
7245
7246
7247 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7248 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7249
7250
7251tcp-check send <data>
7252 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7254 no | no | yes | yes
7255
7256 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7257 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7258
7259 Examples :
7260 # look for the redis master server
7261 option tcp-check
7262 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7263 tcp-check expect string role:master
7264
7265 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7266 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7267
7268
7269tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7270 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7271 tcp health check
7272 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7273 no | no | yes | yes
7274
7275 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7276 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7277 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7278 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7279 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7280 hexadecimal string.
7281 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7282
7283 Examples :
7284 # redis check in binary
7285 option tcp-check
7286 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7287 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7288
7289
7290 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7291 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7292
7293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007294tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7295 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7297 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007298 Arguments :
7299 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007300 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7301 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007303 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007304
7305 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7306 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007307 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7308 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7309 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7310 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7311 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7312 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007313
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007314 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7315 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7316 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7317 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007318
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007319 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007320 - accept :
7321 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7322 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7323 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007325 - reject :
7326 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7327 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7328 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7329 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7330 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7331 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7332 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7333 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7334 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7335 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7336 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7337 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007338
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007339 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7340 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7341 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7342 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7343 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7344 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7345 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7346 hosts.
7347
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007348 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7349 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7350 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7351 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7352 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7353 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7354 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7355 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7356 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7357 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7358 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7359
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007360 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007361 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7362 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7363 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007364 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7365 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007366 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007367 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7368 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7369 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7370 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7371 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007372
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007373 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007374 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007375 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007376 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7377 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7378 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7379 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007380
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007381 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7382 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7383 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7384 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007385
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007386 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7387 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7388 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7389 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7390 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007391 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7392 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7393 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7394 layer7 information is extracted.
7395
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007396 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7397 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7398 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7399 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7400 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007401
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007402 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7403 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7404 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007405
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007406 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7407 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7408 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007409
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007410 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007411 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007412 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007413
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007414 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7415 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7416 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007418 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007419 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7420 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007421
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007422 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7423
7424 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7425
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007426 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7427
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007428 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007429
7430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007431tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7432 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007434 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007435 Arguments :
7436 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007437 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007438 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7439 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007440
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007441 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007442
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007443 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7444 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7445 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7446 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7447 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007449 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7450 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7451 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7452 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007453 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7454 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7455 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7456 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7457 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7458 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007459 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007460 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007461
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007462 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7463 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7464 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7465 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007466
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007467 Four types of actions are supported :
7468 - accept : the request is accepted
7469 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7470 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007471 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007472
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007473 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7474 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007475
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007476 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7477 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7478 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7479 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7480 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7481 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007483 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007484 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7485 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007488 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7489 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7490 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7491 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007492 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7493 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7494 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007495
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007496 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007497 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7498 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7499 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007500
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007501 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007502 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7503 # and reject everything else.
7504 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7505 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007506 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007507 tcp-request content reject
7508
7509 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007510 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7511 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7512 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007513 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007514
7515 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7516 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7517 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007518 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007519 tcp-request content reject
7520
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007521 Example:
7522 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7523 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007524 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007525
7526 Example:
7527 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7528 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007529 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007530
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007531 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7532 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7533
7534 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007535 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007536 # protecting all our sites
7537 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007538 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7539 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007540 ...
7541 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7542
7543 backend http_dynamic
7544 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007545 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007546 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007547 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7548 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7549 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007550 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007552 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007553
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007554 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007555
7556
7557tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7558 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007560 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007561 Arguments :
7562 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7563 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7564 as explained at the top of this document.
7565
7566 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7567 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7568 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7569 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7570 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7571
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007572 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7573 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7574 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7575 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7576
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007577 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7578 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007579 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007580 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007581 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7582 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7583 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7584 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007585
7586 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7587 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7588 it pass through unaffected.
7589
7590 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7591 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7592 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007593 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007594 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7595 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007596 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7597 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7598 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007599
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007600 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007601 "timeout client".
7602
7603
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007604tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7605 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7607 no | no | yes | yes
7608 Arguments :
7609 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007610 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007611
7612 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7613
7614 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7615 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7616 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007617 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7618 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007619
7620 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7621
7622 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7623 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7624 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7625 inserted.
7626
7627 Two types of actions are supported :
7628 - accept :
7629 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7630 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7631 the rules evaluation.
7632
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007633 - close :
7634 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7635 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7636 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7637 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7638 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7639 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007640 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007641 protocols.
7642
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007643 - reject :
7644 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7645 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007646 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007647
7648 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7649 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7650 for changing the default action to a reject.
7651
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007652 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7653 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7654 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7655 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007656 period.
7657
7658 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7659
7660 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7661
7662
7663tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7664 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7666 no | no | yes | yes
7667 Arguments :
7668 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7669 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7670 as explained at the top of this document.
7671
7672 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7673
7674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007675timeout check <timeout>
7676 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7677 established.
7678
7679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7680 yes | no | yes | yes
7681 Arguments:
7682 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7683 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7684 as explained at the top of this document.
7685
7686 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7687 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7688 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7689 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007690 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7691 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7692 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007693
7694 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7695 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7696
7697 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7698 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007699 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007700
7701 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7702 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7703 forget about it.
7704
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007705 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7706 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007707
7708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007709timeout client <timeout>
7710timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7711 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7713 yes | yes | yes | no
7714 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007715 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007716 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7717 as explained at the top of this document.
7718
7719 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7720 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7721 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7722 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7723 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7724 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7725 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7726 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007727 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007728 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007729 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7730 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007731 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7732 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007733
7734 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7735 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7736 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7737 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7738 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7739 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7740
7741 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7742 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7743 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7744
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007745 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007746
7747
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007748timeout client-fin <timeout>
7749 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7751 yes | yes | yes | no
7752 Arguments :
7753 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7754 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7755 as explained at the top of this document.
7756
7757 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7758 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7759 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7760 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7761 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7762 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7763 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7764 down in one direction.
7765
7766 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7767 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7768 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7769
7770 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7771
7772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007773timeout connect <timeout>
7774timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7775 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7777 yes | no | yes | yes
7778 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007779 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007780 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7781 as explained at the top of this document.
7782
7783 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007784 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007785 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007786 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007787 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7788 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007789
7790 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7791 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7792 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7793 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7794 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7795 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7796
7797 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7798 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7799 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7800
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007801 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7802 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007803
7804
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007805timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7806 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7808 yes | yes | yes | yes
7809 Arguments :
7810 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7811 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7812 as explained at the top of this document.
7813
7814 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7815 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7816 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7817 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7818 once the request has started to present itself.
7819
7820 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7821 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7822 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7823 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7824 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7825
7826 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7827 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7828 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7829 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7830
7831 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7832 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7833 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7834 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7835 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007836 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007837
7838 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7839 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7840 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7841 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7842
7843 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7844
7845
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007846timeout http-request <timeout>
7847 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007850 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007851 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007852 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7853 as explained at the top of this document.
7854
7855 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7856 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7857 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7858 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7859 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7860 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7861 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007862 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7863 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7864 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7865 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7866 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7867 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7868 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007869
7870 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7871 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007872 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7873 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007874
7875 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7876 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7877 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7878 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7879 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7880
7881 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007882 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7883 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7884 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007885
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007886 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007887
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007888
7889timeout queue <timeout>
7890 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 yes | no | yes | yes
7893 Arguments :
7894 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7895 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7896 as explained at the top of this document.
7897
7898 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7899 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7900 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7901 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7902 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7903
7904 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7905 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7906 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7907 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7908
7909 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7910
7911
7912timeout server <timeout>
7913timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7914 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7916 yes | no | yes | yes
7917 Arguments :
7918 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7920 as explained at the top of this document.
7921
7922 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7923 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7924 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7925 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7926 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7927 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7928 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7929
7930 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7931 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7932 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7933 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7934 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007935 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007936 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007937 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7938 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7939 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7940 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007941
7942 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7943 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7944 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7945 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7946 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7947 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7948
7949 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7950 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7951 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7952
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007953 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007954
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007955
7956timeout server-fin <timeout>
7957 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7959 yes | no | yes | yes
7960 Arguments :
7961 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7962 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7963 as explained at the top of this document.
7964
7965 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7966 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7967 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7968 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7969 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7970 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7971 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7972 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7973 situations, it should not be needed.
7974
7975 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7976 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7977 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7978
7979 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7980
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007981
7982timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007983 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7985 yes | yes | yes | yes
7986 Arguments :
7987 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7988 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7989 as explained at the top of this document.
7990
7991 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7992 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7993 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7994
7995 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7996 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7997 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7998 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007999 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008000
8001 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8002
8003
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008004timeout tunnel <timeout>
8005 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8007 yes | no | yes | yes
8008 Arguments :
8009 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8010 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8011 as explained at the top of this document.
8012
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008013 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008014 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8015 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8016 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8017 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8018 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8019 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8020 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8021 specified.
8022
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008023 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8024 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8025 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8026 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8027 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8028 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8029 state.
8030
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008031 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8032 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8033 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8034 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8035 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8036
8037 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8038 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8039 forget about it.
8040
8041 Example :
8042 defaults http
8043 option http-server-close
8044 timeout connect 5s
8045 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008046 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008047 timeout server 30s
8048 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8049
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008050 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008051
8052
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008053transparent (deprecated)
8054 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008056 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008057 Arguments : none
8058
8059 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8060 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8061 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8062 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8063 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8064 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8065 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8066 appropriate server.
8067
8068 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8069
8070 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8071 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8072
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008073 See also: "option transparent"
8074
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008075unique-id-format <string>
8076 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8078 yes | yes | yes | no
8079 Arguments :
8080 <string> is a log-format string.
8081
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008082 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8083 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8084 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8085 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008086
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008087 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8088 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8089 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8090 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8091 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8092 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8093 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8094 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008095
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008096 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8097 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008098
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008099 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008100
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008101 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008102
8103 will generate:
8104
8105 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8106
8107 See also: "unique-id-header"
8108
8109unique-id-header <name>
8110 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | yes | yes | no
8113 Arguments :
8114 <name> is the name of the header.
8115
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008116 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8117 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008118
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008119 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008120
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008121 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008122 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8123
8124 will generate:
8125
8126 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8127
8128 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008129
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008130use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008131 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8133 no | yes | yes | no
8134 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008135 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8136 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008137
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008138 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8139 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008140
8141 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8142 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8143 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008144 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8145 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8146 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8147 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008148
8149 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8150 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8151 assign the backend.
8152
8153 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8154 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8155 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8156 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8157 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8158 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8159
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008160 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008161 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008162 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8163 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8164 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8165
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008166 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8167 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8168 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8169 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8170 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8171 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8172 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8173 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8174 cannot be forced from the request.
8175
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008176 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008177 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8178 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8179
8180 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8181 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008182
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008183
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008184use-server <server> if <condition>
8185use-server <server> unless <condition>
8186 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8188 no | no | yes | yes
8189 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008190 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008191
8192 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8193
8194 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8195 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8196 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8197
8198 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8199 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8200 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8201 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8202 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8203 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8204 matches will assign the server.
8205
8206 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8207 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8208 with the next rules until one matches.
8209
8210 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8211 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8212 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8213 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8214
8215 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8216 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8217 stripped.
8218
8219 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8220 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8221 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8222 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8223
8224 Example :
8225 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8226 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8227 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8228 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8229 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8230 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8231 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8232 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8233 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8234
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008235 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008236
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008237
82385. Bind and Server options
8239--------------------------
8240
8241The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8242depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8243settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8244written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8245described in this section.
8246
8247
82485.1. Bind options
8249-----------------
8250
8251The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8252as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8253no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8254parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8255while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8256provided immediately after the setting name.
8257
8258The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8259
8260accept-proxy
8261 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008262 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8263 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008264 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8265 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8266 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8267 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8268 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8269 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8270 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008271 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8272 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008273
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008274alpn <protocols>
8275 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8276 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8277 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8278 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8279 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8280 initial NPN extension.
8281
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008282backlog <backlog>
8283 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8284 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8285
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008286ecdhe <named curve>
8287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008288 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8289 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008290
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008291ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8293 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8294 client's certificate.
8295
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008296ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8298 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8299 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8300 error is ignored.
8301
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008302ciphers <ciphers>
8303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8304 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008305 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008306 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8307 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8308
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008309crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8311 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8312 to verify client's certificate.
8313
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008314crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8316 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8317 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8318 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8319 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8320 file.
8321
8322 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8323 are loaded.
8324
8325 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008326 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8327 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008328 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8329 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8330 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8331 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8332 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8333 www.sub.example.org).
8334
8335 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8336 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8337 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8338 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8339 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8340
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008341 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008342
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008343 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8344 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008345 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008346 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8347 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8348 clients).
8349
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008350 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8351 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8352 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8353 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8354 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8355 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8356 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8357 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8358 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8359 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8360 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8361 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8362 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8363
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008364crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8366 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008367 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008368 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008369
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008370crt-list <file>
8371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008372 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8373 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008374
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008375 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008376
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008377 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8378 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8379 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8380 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8381 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8382 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8383 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8384 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008385
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008386defer-accept
8387 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8388 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8389 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8390 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8391 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8392 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8393 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8394 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8395 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8396 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8397 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8398
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008399force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008400 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008401 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008402 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8403 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008404
8405force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008406 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008407 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8408 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008409
8410force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008411 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008412 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8413 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008414
8415force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008416 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008417 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8418 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008419
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008420gid <gid>
8421 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8422 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8423 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8424 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8425 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8426
8427group <group>
8428 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8429 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8430 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8431 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8432 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8433
8434id <id>
8435 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8436 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8437 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8438 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8439
8440interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008441 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8442 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8443 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8444 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8445 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8446 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8447 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008448
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008449level <level>
8450 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8451 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8452 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8453 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8454 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8455 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8456 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8457 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8458 counters).
8459 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8460 all counters).
8461
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008462maxconn <maxconn>
8463 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8464 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8465 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8466 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8467 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8468 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8469 eat all memory.
8470
8471mode <mode>
8472 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8473 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8474 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8475 UNIX sockets.
8476
8477mss <maxseg>
8478 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8479 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8480 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8481 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8482 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8483 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8484 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8485 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8486 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8487 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8488 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8489
8490name <name>
8491 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8492 page.
8493
8494nice <nice>
8495 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8496 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8497 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8498 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8499 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8500 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8501 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8502 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8503 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8504 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8505 one for an RDP socket.
8506
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008507no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008509 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008510 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008511 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8512 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008513 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008514
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008515no-tls-tickets
8516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8517 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8518 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008519 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8520 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008521
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008522no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008524 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008525 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008526 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8527 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8528 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008529
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008530no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008531 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008532 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008533 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008534 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8535 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8536 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008537
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008538no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008539 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008540 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008541 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008542 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8543 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8544 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008545
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008546npn <protocols>
8547 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8548 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8549 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8550 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008551 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8552 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008553
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008554process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8555 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8556 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8557 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8558 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8559 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8560 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8561 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008562 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8563 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8564 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8565 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8566 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8567 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8568 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008569
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008570ssl
8571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008572 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008573 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8574 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8575 to deciphered contents.
8576
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008577strict-sni
8578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8579 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8580 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8581 See the "crt" option for more information.
8582
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008583tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008584 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008585 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8586 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8587 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8588 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8589 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8590 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8591 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008592 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8593 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8594 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008595
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008596transparent
8597 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8598 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8599 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8600 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8601 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8602 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8603 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8604 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8605 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8606 so check for support with your vendor.
8607
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008608v4v6
8609 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8610 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8611 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8612 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008613 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008614
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008615v6only
8616 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8617 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8618 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008619 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8620 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008621
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008622uid <uid>
8623 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8624 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8625 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8626 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8627 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8628
8629user <user>
8630 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8631 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8632 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8633 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8634 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8635
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008636verify [none|optional|required]
8637 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8638 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8639 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8640 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8641 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008642 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8643 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8644 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8645 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008646
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086475.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008648------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008650The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8651which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8652arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8653settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8654after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8655Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8656address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008658 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008659 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008661The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008662
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008663addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008664 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8665 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8666 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8667 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8668 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008670 Supported in default-server: No
8671
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008672agent-check
8673 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008674 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8675 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8676 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8677 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008678
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008679 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008680 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008681 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8682 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8683 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008684
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008685 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8686 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008687
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008688 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8689 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8690 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008691
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008692 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8693 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8694 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008695
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008696 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8697 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8698 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8699 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8700 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8701 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8702 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008703
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008704 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8705 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008706
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008707 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8708 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8709 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8710 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8711 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8712 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8713 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8714 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8715 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008716
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008717 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8718 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008719 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8720 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8721 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8722 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008723
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008724 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8725 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008726
8727 Supported in default-server: No
8728
8729agent-inter <delay>
8730 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8731 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8732
8733 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8734 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8735 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8736 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8737 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8738 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8739 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8740 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8741 of backends use the same servers.
8742
8743 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8744
8745 Supported in default-server: Yes
8746
8747agent-port <port>
8748 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8749
8750 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8751
8752 Supported in default-server: Yes
8753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008754backup
8755 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8756 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8757 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8758 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8759 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8760 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008761
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008762 Supported in default-server: No
8763
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008764ca-file <cafile>
8765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8766 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8767 server's certificate.
8768
8769 Supported in default-server: No
8770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008771check
8772 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008773 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8774 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8775 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8776 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8777 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8778 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8779 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008780 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8781 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8782 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008784 Supported in default-server: No
8785
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008786check-send-proxy
8787 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8788 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8789 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8790 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8791 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8792 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8793 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8794
8795 Supported in default-server: No
8796
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008797check-ssl
8798 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8799 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8800 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8801 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008802 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008803 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8804 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8805 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8806 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8807
8808 Supported in default-server: No
8809
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008810ciphers <ciphers>
8811 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008812 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008813 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8814 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8815 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8816 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8817 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8818 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8819
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008820 Supported in default-server: No
8821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008822cookie <value>
8823 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8824 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8825 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8826 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8827 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8828 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8829 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008831 Supported in default-server: No
8832
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008833crl-file <crlfile>
8834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8835 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8836 to verify server's certificate.
8837
8838 Supported in default-server: No
8839
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008840crt <cert>
8841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8842 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8843 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8844 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8845 certificate request.
8846
8847 Supported in default-server: No
8848
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008849disabled
8850 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8851 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8852 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8853 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8854 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8855
8856 Supported in default-server: No
8857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008858error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008859 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8860 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8861 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008863 Supported in default-server: Yes
8864
8865 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008867fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008868 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8869 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8870 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008872 Supported in default-server: Yes
8873
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008874force-sslv3
8875 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8876 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008877 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8878 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008879
8880 Supported in default-server: No
8881
8882force-tlsv10
8883 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008884 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8885 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008886
8887 Supported in default-server: No
8888
8889force-tlsv11
8890 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008891 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8892 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008893
8894 Supported in default-server: No
8895
8896force-tlsv12
8897 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008898 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8899 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008900
8901 Supported in default-server: No
8902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008903id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008904 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8905 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8906 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008908 Supported in default-server: No
8909
8910inter <delay>
8911fastinter <delay>
8912downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008913 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8914 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8915 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8916 between checks depending on the server state :
8917
8918 Server state | Interval used
8919 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8920 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8921 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8922 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8923 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8924 or yet unchecked. |
8925 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8926 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8927 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008929 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8930 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8931 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8932 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008933 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8934 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8935 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8936 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8937 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008939 Supported in default-server: Yes
8940
8941maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008942 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8943 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8944 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8945 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8946 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8947 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8948 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8949 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008951 Supported in default-server: Yes
8952
8953maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008954 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8955 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8956 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8957 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8958 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8959 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8960 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008962 Supported in default-server: Yes
8963
8964minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008965 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8966 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8967 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8968 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8969 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8970 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008971 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008972 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008974 Supported in default-server: Yes
8975
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008976no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008977 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8978 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008979 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008980
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008981 Supported in default-server: No
8982
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008983no-tls-tickets
8984 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8985 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8986 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008987 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
8988 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008989
8990 Supported in default-server: No
8991
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008992no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008993 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008994 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8995 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008996 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
8997 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
8998 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008999
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009000 Supported in default-server: No
9001
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009002no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009003 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009004 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9005 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009006 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9007 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9008 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009009
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009010 Supported in default-server: No
9011
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009012no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009013 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009014 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9015 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009016 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9017 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9018 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009019
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009020 Supported in default-server: No
9021
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009022non-stick
9023 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9024 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9025 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9026
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009027 Supported in default-server: No
9028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009029observe <mode>
9030 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9031 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9032 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9033 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9034 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9035 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009036 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009038 Supported in default-server: No
9039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009040 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009042on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009043 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9044 Currently, four modes are available:
9045 - fastinter: force fastinter
9046 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9047 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9048 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9049 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009051 Supported in default-server: Yes
9052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009053 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9054
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009055on-marked-down <action>
9056 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9057 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009058 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9059 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9060 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9061 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9062 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9063 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9064 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9065 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009066
9067 Actions are disabled by default
9068
9069 Supported in default-server: Yes
9070
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009071on-marked-up <action>
9072 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9073 Currently one action is available:
9074 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9075 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9076 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9077 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9078 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9079 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9080 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9081 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9082
9083 Actions are disabled by default
9084
9085 Supported in default-server: Yes
9086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009087port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009088 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9089 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9090 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9091 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9092 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9093 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009095 Supported in default-server: Yes
9096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009097redir <prefix>
9098 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9099 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9100 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9101 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9102 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9103 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9104 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9105 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009106 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009107 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9108 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9109 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9110 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9111 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9112
9113 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009115 Supported in default-server: No
9116
9117rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009118 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9119 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9120 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009122 Supported in default-server: Yes
9123
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009124send-proxy
9125 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9126 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9127 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9128 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9129 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9130 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9131 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9132 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9133 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009134 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9135 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9136 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9137 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9138 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009139
9140 Supported in default-server: No
9141
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009142send-proxy-v2
9143 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9144 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9145 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9146 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9147 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9148 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9149 option of the "bind" keyword.
9150
9151 Supported in default-server: No
9152
9153send-proxy-v2-ssl
9154 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9155 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9156 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9157 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9158 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9159 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9160 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9161 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9162
9163 Supported in default-server: No
9164
9165send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9166 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9167 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9168 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9169 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9170 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9171 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9172 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9173 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9174 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9175
9176 Supported in default-server: No
9177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009178slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009179 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9180 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9181 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9182 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9183 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9184 parameters :
9185
9186 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9187 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9188
9189 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9190 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9191 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9192 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9193
9194 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9195 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9196 seen as failed.
9197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009198 Supported in default-server: Yes
9199
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009200source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009201source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009202source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009203 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9204 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9205 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9206 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9207
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009208 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9209 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9210 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9211 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9212 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9213 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9214 server.
9215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009216 Supported in default-server: No
9217
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009218ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009219 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9220 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9221 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9222 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9223 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9224 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009225 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009226
9227 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009229track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009230 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9231 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9232 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9233 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009234 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009236 Supported in default-server: No
9237
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009238verify [none|required]
9239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009240 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9241 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9242 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9243 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009244 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9245 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9246 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009247
9248 Supported in default-server: No
9249
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009250verifyhost <hostname>
9251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9252 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9253 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9254 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9255 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9256 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9257
9258 Supported in default-server: No
9259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009260weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009261 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9262 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9263 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009264 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9265 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9266 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9267 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9268 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9269 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009271 Supported in default-server: Yes
9272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009273
92746. HTTP header manipulation
9275---------------------------
9276
9277In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9278response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9279request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9280which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009281against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009282
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009283If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9284to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9285but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9286HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9287stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9288because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9289a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9290still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009292This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9293in section 4.2 :
9294
9295 - reqadd <string>
9296 - reqallow <search>
9297 - reqiallow <search>
9298 - reqdel <search>
9299 - reqidel <search>
9300 - reqdeny <search>
9301 - reqideny <search>
9302 - reqpass <search>
9303 - reqipass <search>
9304 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9305 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9306 - reqtarpit <search>
9307 - reqitarpit <search>
9308 - rspadd <string>
9309 - rspdel <search>
9310 - rspidel <search>
9311 - rspdeny <search>
9312 - rspideny <search>
9313 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9314 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9315
9316With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9317is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9318parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9319prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9320Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9321
9322 \t for a tab
9323 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9324 \n for a new line (LF)
9325 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9326 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9327 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9328 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9329 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9330
9331The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9332portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9333above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9334regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93359 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9336is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9337
9338The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9339after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9340
9341Notes related to these keywords :
9342---------------------------------
9343 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9344 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9345 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9346
9347 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9348 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9349 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9350
9351 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9352 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9353 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9354 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9355 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9356
9357 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9358 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9359 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9360 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9361 useless headers before adding new ones.
9362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009363 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009364 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9365
9366 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9367 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9368 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9369
9370 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9371 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009372 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009373
9374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9376----------------------------------
9377
9378Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9379client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9380The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9381these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9382but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9383data called patterns.
9384
9385
93867.1. ACL basics
9387---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009388
9389The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9390content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9391from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9392simple :
9393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009394 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009395 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009396 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9397 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009399The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9400adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009401
9402In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009404 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009405
9406This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9407Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9408and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009409an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9410conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9411as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9412are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009413
9414ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9415'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9416which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9417
9418There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9419performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009421The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9422specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9423this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009424methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9425ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426
9427Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9428 - boolean
9429 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9430 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9431 - string
9432 - data block
9433
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009434Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9435converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9436would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9437The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9438which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9439
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009440Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9441keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9442fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9443which are summarized in the table below :
9444
9445 +---------------------+-----------------+
9446 | Sample or converter | Default |
9447 | output type | matching method |
9448 +---------------------+-----------------+
9449 | boolean | bool |
9450 +---------------------+-----------------+
9451 | integer | int |
9452 +---------------------+-----------------+
9453 | ip | ip |
9454 +---------------------+-----------------+
9455 | string | str |
9456 +---------------------+-----------------+
9457 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9458 +---------------------+-----------------+
9459
9460Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9461matching method, see below.
9462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009463The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9464 - boolean
9465 - integer or integer range
9466 - IP address / network
9467 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9468 - regular expression
9469 - hex block
9470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009471The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9472
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009473 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9474 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009475 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009476 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009477 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009478 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009479 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009481The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9482read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9483if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9484lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9485will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9486beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9487a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9488lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9489exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9490
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009491The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9492parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9493ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9494a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9495check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9496
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009497The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9498socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9499file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009501Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9502loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9503
9504 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9505
9506In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9507the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9508case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9509as well.
9510
9511The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9512sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9513do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9514methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9515is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9516obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9517followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9518default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9519that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9520string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9521
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009522The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9523By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9524string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9525resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9526server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9527waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9528flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9529function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009531There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9532sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9533be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009534
9535 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9536 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009537 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9538 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9539 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9540 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009541
9542 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9543 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009544 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009545
9546 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009547 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009548
9549 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009550 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009551
9552 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9553 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9554
9555 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9556 binary or string samples.
9557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9559 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009561 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9562 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9563 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009565 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9566 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009568 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9569 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009571 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9572 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009574 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9575 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009576 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009578 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9579 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9580 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009581
9582For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9583request, it is possible to do :
9584
9585 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9586
9587In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9588buffer, one would use the following acl :
9589
9590 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9591
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009592On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9593possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9594
9595 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009597All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9598criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9599method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9600to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9601criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9602the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009604If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009605the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9606For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009608 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9609 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9610 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9611 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009612
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009613
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009614The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9615types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9616combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9617brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9618default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009620 +-------------------------------------------------+
9621 | Input sample type |
9622 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009623 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009624 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9625 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9626 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009627 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009628 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009629 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009630 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009631 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009632 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009633 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009634 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009635 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009637 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009638 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009639 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009640 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009641 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009642 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009643 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009644 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009645 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009646 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009647 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009648 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9649 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9650 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009651
9652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096537.1.1. Matching booleans
9654------------------------
9655
9656In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9657Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9658When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9659that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9660
9661Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9662return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9663"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9664
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096667.1.2. Matching integers
9667------------------------
9668
9669Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9670enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9671to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9672
9673Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9674matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9675lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009676
9677For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9678unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9679representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9680
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009681As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9682two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9683instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9684ranges and operators.
9685
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009686For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009687operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9688Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9689of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009691Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009692
9693 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9694 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9695 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9696 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9697 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9698
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009699For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009700
9701 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9702
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009703This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9704
9705 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097087.1.3. Matching strings
9709-----------------------
9710
9711String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9712different forms :
9713
9714 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9715 patterns ;
9716
9717 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9718 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9719
9720 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9721 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9722
9723 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9724 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9725
9726 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9727 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9728 matches.
9729
9730 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9731 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9732 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009733
9734String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9735exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9736characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9737string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9738to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009739before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009740
9741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097427.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9743---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009744
9745Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9746they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9747possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9748passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9749the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009750the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9751match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009752
9753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097547.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9755-------------------------------------
9756
9757It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9758not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9759a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9760to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9761digits may be used upper or lower case.
9762
9763Example :
9764 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9765 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9766
9767
97687.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9769---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009770
9771IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9772netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9773within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009774host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009775difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9776at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9777does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9778parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009779
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009780IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9781Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9782trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9783IPv6 patterns.
9784
9785HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9786following situations :
9787 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9788 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9789 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9790 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9791 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9792 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9793 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9794 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9795 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9796 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009798
97997.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9800----------------------------------
9801
9802Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9803combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9804
9805 - AND (implicit)
9806 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9807 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009809A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009811 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009813Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9814indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009816For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9817"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9818requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9819is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9820
9821 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9822 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9823 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9824 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9825
9826To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9827and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9828
9829 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9830 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9831 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9832 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9833
9834 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9835 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9836 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9837 use_backend www if host_www
9838
9839It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9840expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9841be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9842the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9843
9844 The following rule :
9845
9846 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9847 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9848
9849 Can also be written that way :
9850
9851 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9852
9853It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9854to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9855simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9856sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9857good use is the following :
9858
9859 With named ACLs :
9860
9861 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9862 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9863 monitor fail if site_dead
9864
9865 With anonymous ACLs :
9866
9867 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9868
9869See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9870
9871
98727.3. Fetching samples
9873---------------------
9874
9875Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9876against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9877sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9878ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9879of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9880available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9881
9882This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9883Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9884compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9885deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9886
9887The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9888matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9889method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9890indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9891
9892As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9893when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9894mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9895the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9896ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9897
9898Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9899multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9900when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9901incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9902are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9903is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9904all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9905
9906Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9907 - name
9908 - name(arg1)
9909 - name(arg1,arg2)
9910
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009911
99127.3.1. Converters
9913-----------------
9914
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009915Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9916of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9917is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9918was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9919has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9920unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9921
9922These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9923sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9924the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9925support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009927The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009928
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009929base64
9930 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9931 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9932 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9933
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009934hex
9935 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9936 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9937 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9938 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009939
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009940http_date([<offset>])
9941 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9942 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9943 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9944 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9945 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9946 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009947
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009948ipmask(<mask>)
9949 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9950 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9951 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9952 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9953
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009954language(<value>[,<default>])
9955 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9956 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9957 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9958 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9959 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9960 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9961 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9962 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9963 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9964 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9965 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9966 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009967
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009968 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009969
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009970 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9971 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009972
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009973 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9974 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9975 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9976 use_backend spanish if es
9977 use_backend french if fr
9978 use_backend english if en
9979 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009980
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009981lower
9982 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9983 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9984 type. The result is of type string.
9985
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009986map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9987map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9988map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9989 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9990 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9991 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9992 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9993 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9994 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9995 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9996 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009997
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009998 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9999 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10000 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010001
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010002 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10003 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010004
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010005 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10006 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10007 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10008 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010009 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10010 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010011 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10012 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10013 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10014 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10015 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10016 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10017 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10018 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10019 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10020 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10021 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10022 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10023 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10024 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010025
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010026 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10027 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10028 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10029 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10030 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010031
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010032 Example :
10033
10034 # this is a comment and is ignored
10035 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10036 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10037 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10038 | | | `---------- value
10039 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10040 | `---------------------------- key
10041 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10042
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010043upper
10044 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10045 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10046 type. The result is of type string.
10047
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100497.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010050--------------------------------------------
10051
10052A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10053not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10054"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10055The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10056
10057always_false : boolean
10058 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10059 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10060
10061always_true : boolean
10062 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10063 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10064
10065avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010066 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010067 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10068 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10069 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10070 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10071 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10072 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10073 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10074 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10075 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10076 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10077 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10078 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10079 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010081be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010082 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10083 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10084 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10085 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10086 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010088be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10089 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10090 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10091 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10092 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10093 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10094 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010095
10096 Example :
10097 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10098 backend dynamic
10099 mode http
10100 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10101 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010103connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010105 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010106 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10107 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010108
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010109 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010110 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010111 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10112
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010113 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10114 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010115
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010116 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010117 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010119 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10120 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010121 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010122 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010123
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010124 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10125 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010126 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010127 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010128
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010129date([<offset>]) : integer
10130 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10131 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10132 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10133 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010134 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10135
10136 Example :
10137
10138 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10139 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010140
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010141env(<name>) : string
10142 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10143 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10144 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10145 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10146 certain way.
10147
10148 Examples :
10149 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10150 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10151
10152 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10153 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010155fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10156 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010157 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10158 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010159 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10160 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10161 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10162 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10163 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010165fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10166 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10167 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10168 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10169 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10170 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10171 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10172 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10173 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010174
10175 Example :
10176 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10177 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10178 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10179 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10180 frontend mail
10181 bind :25
10182 mode tcp
10183 maxconn 100
10184 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10185 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10186 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10187 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010188
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010189nbproc : integer
10190 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10191 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10192 and debugging purposes.
10193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010194nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10195 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10196 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10197 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010198 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10199 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10200 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010201
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010202proc : integer
10203 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10204 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10205 debugging purposes.
10206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010207queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010208 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10209 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10210 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010211 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10212 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10213 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10214 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10215 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10216
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010217rand([<range>]) : integer
10218 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10219 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10220 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10221 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10222 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010224srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10225 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10226 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10227 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10228 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10229 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10230 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10231 methods.
10232
10233srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10234 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10235 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10236 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10237 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10238 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10239 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10240 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10241
10242srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10243 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10244 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010245 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010246 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10247 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10248 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10249 overloading servers).
10250
10251 Example :
10252 # Redirect to a separate back
10253 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10254 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10255 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10256
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010257stopping : boolean
10258 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10259 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10260 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010262table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10263 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10264 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10265
10266table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10267 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10268 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10269 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10270
10271
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102727.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010273----------------------------------
10274
10275The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10276closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10277methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10278sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10279TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010280the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10281counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10282"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010283argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10284the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10285this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286
10287be_id : integer
10288 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10289 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10290
10291dst : ip
10292 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10293 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10294 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10295 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10296 RFC 4291.
10297
10298dst_conn : integer
10299 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10300 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10301 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10302 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10303 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10304 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10305 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10306 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010308dst_port : integer
10309 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10310 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10311 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10312 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10313 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10314 an HTTP header.
10315
10316fe_id : integer
10317 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10318 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10319 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10320
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010321sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010322sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10323sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10324sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010325 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10326 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10327 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10328
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010329sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010330sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10331sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10332sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010333 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10334 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10335 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10336
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010337sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010338sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10339sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10340sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010341 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10342 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010343 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10344 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10345 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010346
10347 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10348 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010349 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10350 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10351 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010352 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10353 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10354
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010355sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010356sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10357sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10358sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010359 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10360 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010362sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010363sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10364sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10365sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010366 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10367 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10368 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010370sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010371sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10372sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10373sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010374 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10375 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10376 See also src_conn_rate.
10377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010378sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010379sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10380sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10381sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010382 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010383 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010385sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010386sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10387sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10388sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010389 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10390 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10391 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010392 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10393 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10394 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010395
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010396sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010397sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10398sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10399sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010400 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10401 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10402 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10403
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010404sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010405sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10406sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10407sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010408 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10409 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10410 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10411 src_http_err_rate.
10412
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010413sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010414sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10415sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10416sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010417 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10418 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10419 src_http_req_cnt.
10420
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010421sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010422sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10423sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10424sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010425 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10426 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10427 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10428 src_http_req_rate.
10429
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010430sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010431sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10432sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10433sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010434 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010435 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10436 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10437 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10438 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010439
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010440 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10441 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010442 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010444sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010445sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10446sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10447sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010448 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10449 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10450 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010451
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010452sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010453sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10454sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10455sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010456 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10457 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10458 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010459
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010460sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010461sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10462sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10463sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010464 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10465 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10466 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10467 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010468 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010469 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10470
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010471sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010472sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10473sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10474sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010475 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10476 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10477 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10478 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10479 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010480 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010481
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010482sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010483sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10484sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10485sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010486 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10487 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10488 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10489
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010490sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010491sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10492sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10493sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010494 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10495 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010496 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010497 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10498 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010499 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10500 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10501 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010503so_id : integer
10504 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10505 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10506 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010508src : ip
10509 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10510 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10511 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10512 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10513 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10514 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10515 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010516
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010517 Example:
10518 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10519 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010521src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10522 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10523 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10524 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010525 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010527src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10528 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10529 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010530 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010531 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010533src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10534 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10535 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10536 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10537 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10538 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10539 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010540
10541 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10542 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10543 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10544 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010545 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010546 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10547 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010549src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010550 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010552 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010553 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010555src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010556 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010557 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10558 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010559 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010561src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10562 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10563 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10564 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010565 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010568 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010569 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010570 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010571 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010573src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010574 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010575 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010576 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10577 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010578 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10579 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10580 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010582src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10583 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10584 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010585 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010586 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010589src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10590 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10591 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10592 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10593 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010594 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10597 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10598 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10599 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010600 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10603 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10604 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10605 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010606 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010607 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010609src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10610 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10611 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10612 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010613 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10615 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010616
10617 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010618 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010619 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010621src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010622 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10623 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10624 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10625 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10626 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010629 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10630 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10631 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10632 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10633 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010635src_port : integer
10636 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10637 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10638 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10639 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010641src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10642 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010643 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10644 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10645 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010646 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010648src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10649 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10650 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10651 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10652 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010653 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010655src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10656 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10657 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10658 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10659 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10660 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10661 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10662 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10663 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010664
10665 Example :
10666 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10667 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10668 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10669 listen ssh
10670 bind :22
10671 mode tcp
10672 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010673 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010674 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010675 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010677srv_id : integer
10678 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10679 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10680 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010681
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106837.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010684----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010686The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10687closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10688when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10689usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010690future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010691
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010692ssl_bc : boolean
10693 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10694 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10695 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10696
10697ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10698 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10699 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10700
10701ssl_bc_cipher : string
10702 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10703 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10704
10705ssl_bc_protocol : string
10706 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10707 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10708
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010709ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010710 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010711 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10712 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010713
10714ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10715 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10716 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10717 if session was reused or not.
10718
10719ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10720 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10721 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010723ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10724 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10725 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10726 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10727 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10728 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010730ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10731 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10732 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10733 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10734 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010735
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010736ssl_c_der : binary
10737 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10738 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10739 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010741ssl_c_err : integer
10742 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10743 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10744 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10745 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10746 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010748ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10749 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10750 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10751 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10752 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10753 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10754 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10755 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10756 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010758ssl_c_key_alg : string
10759 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10760 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10761 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010763ssl_c_notafter : string
10764 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10765 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10766 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010768ssl_c_notbefore : string
10769 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10770 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10771 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010773ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10774 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10775 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10776 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10777 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10778 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10779 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10780 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10781 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010783ssl_c_serial : binary
10784 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10785 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10786 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010788ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10789 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10790 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10791 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010792 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10793 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10794
10795 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010797ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10798 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10799 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10800 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010802ssl_c_used : boolean
10803 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10804 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806ssl_c_verify : integer
10807 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10808 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10809 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10810 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010812ssl_c_version : integer
10813 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10814 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010815
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010816ssl_f_der : binary
10817 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10818 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10819 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010821ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10822 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10823 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10824 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10825 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010826 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010827 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10828 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10829 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010831ssl_f_key_alg : string
10832 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10833 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10834 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010836ssl_f_notafter : string
10837 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10838 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10839 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010841ssl_f_notbefore : string
10842 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10843 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10844 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010846ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10847 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10848 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10849 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10850 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10851 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10852 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10853 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10854 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010856ssl_f_serial : binary
10857 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10858 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10859 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010860
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010861ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10862 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10863 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10864 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010866ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10867 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10868 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10869 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010871ssl_f_version : integer
10872 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10873 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10874
10875ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010876 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10877 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10878 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010880 Example :
10881 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10882 listen http-https
10883 bind :80
10884 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10885 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10886
10887ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10888 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10889 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10890
10891ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010892 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10894 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10895 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10896 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10897 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10898 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10899 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10900 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010902ssl_fc_cipher : string
10903 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10904 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010906ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010907 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10908 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010909 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10910 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10911 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10912 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010914ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10915 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010916 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10917 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10918 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10919 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010921ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010922 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010923 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10924 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10925 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10926 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10927 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10928 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10929 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010931ssl_fc_protocol : string
10932 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10933 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010934
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010935ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010936 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010937 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10938 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10941 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10942 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10943 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10944 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010946ssl_fc_sni : string
10947 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10948 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10949 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10950 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10951 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10952
10953 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10954 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10955 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010956 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10957 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010959 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010960 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10961 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010963ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10964 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10965 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010966
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010967
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109687.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010969------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010971Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10972sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10973only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10974For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10975be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10976can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10977sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10978for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10979content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010981payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10982 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10983 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10984 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010986payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10987 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10988 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10989 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010991req.len : integer
10992req_len : integer (deprecated)
10993 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10994 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10995 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10996 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10997 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10998 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10999 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11000 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011002req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11003 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011004 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11005 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11006 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11007 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011009 ACL alternatives :
11010 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011012req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11013 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11014 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11015 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11016 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011018 ACL alternatives :
11019 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011021 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011023req.proto_http : boolean
11024req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11025 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11026 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11027 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11028 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11029 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11030 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11031 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011033 Example:
11034 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11035 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11036 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011037 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011039req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11040rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11041 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11042 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11043 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11044 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11045 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11046 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11047 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011049 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11050 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11051 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11052 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11053 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11054 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056 ACL derivatives :
11057 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011059 Example :
11060 listen tse-farm
11061 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11062 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11063 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11064 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11065 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11066 persist rdp-cookie
11067 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11068 # This is only useful makes sense if
11069 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11070 stick-table type string size 204800
11071 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11072 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11073 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011075 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11076 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011078req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11079rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11080 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11081 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11082 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11083 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011085 ACL derivatives :
11086 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011088req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11089req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11090 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11091 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11092 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11093 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11094 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11095 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11096 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011098req.ssl_sni : string
11099req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11100 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11101 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11102 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11103 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11104 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11105 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11106 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11107 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11108 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11109 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11110 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11111 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011113 ACL derivatives :
11114 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011116 Examples :
11117 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11118 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11119 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11120 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11121 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011123res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11124rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11125 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11126 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11127 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11128 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11129 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11130 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11131 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011133req.ssl_ver : integer
11134req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11135 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11136 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11137 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11138 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11139 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11140 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11141 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11142 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11143 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011145 ACL derivatives :
11146 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011147
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011148res.len : integer
11149 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11150 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11151 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11152 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11153 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11154 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11155 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11156 content inspection.
11157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011158res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11159 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011160 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11161 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11162 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11163 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011165res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11166 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11167 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11168 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11169 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011171 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011173wait_end : boolean
11174 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11175 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11176 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11177 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11178 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11179 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11180 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11181 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011183 Examples :
11184 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11185 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11186 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011188 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11189 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11190 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11191 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11192 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11193 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11194 tcp-request content reject
11195
11196
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111977.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011198--------------------------------------
11199
11200It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11201This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11202data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11203its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11204HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11205content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11206to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11207more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11208response are indexed.
11209
11210base : string
11211 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11212 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11213 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11214 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11215 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11216 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11217 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11218 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11219
11220 ACL derivatives :
11221 base : exact string match
11222 base_beg : prefix match
11223 base_dir : subdir match
11224 base_dom : domain match
11225 base_end : suffix match
11226 base_len : length match
11227 base_reg : regex match
11228 base_sub : substring match
11229
11230base32 : integer
11231 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11232 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11233 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11234 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11235
11236base32+src : binary
11237 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11238 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11239 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11240 per-URL counters.
11241
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011242capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11243 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11244 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11245 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11246
11247capture.req.method : string
11248 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11249 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11250 because it's allocated.
11251
11252capture.req.uri : string
11253 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11254 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11255 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11256 allocated.
11257
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011258capture.req.ver : string
11259 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11260 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11261 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11262
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011263capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11264 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11265 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11266 The first entry is an index of 0.
11267 See also: "capture response header"
11268
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011269capture.res.ver : string
11270 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11271 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11272 persistent flag.
11273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011274req.cook([<name>]) : string
11275cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11276 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11277 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11278 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11279 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11280 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11281 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11282 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11283 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11284
11285 ACL derivatives :
11286 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11287 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11288 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11289 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11290 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11291 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11292 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11293 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011295req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11296cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11297 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11298 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011300req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11301cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11302 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11303 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11304 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11305 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011307cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11308 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11309 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11310 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11311 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11312 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11313 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11314 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11315 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11316 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11317 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011319hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11320 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11321 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11322 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11323 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011324 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011326req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11327 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11328 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11329 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11330 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11331 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11332 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11333 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11334 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011336req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11337 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11338 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11339 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11340 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11343 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11344 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11345 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11346 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11347 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11348 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11349 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11350 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11351 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11352 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11353 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011355 ACL derivatives :
11356 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11357 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11358 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11359 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11360 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11361 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11362 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11363 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11364
11365req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11366hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11367 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11368 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11369 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11370 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11371 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11372 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11373 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11374 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11375 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11376
11377req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11378hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11379 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11380 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11381 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11382 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11383 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11384 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11385 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11386 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11387
11388req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11389hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11390 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11391 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11392 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11393 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11394 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11395 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11396 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11397
11398http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11399 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11400 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11401 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11402 basic auth is supported.
11403
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011404http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11405 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11406 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11407 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11408 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011409 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11410 basic auth is supported.
11411
11412 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011413 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11414 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11415 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11416 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011417
11418http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011419 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11420 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011421 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11422 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011424method : integer + string
11425 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11426 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11427 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11428 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11429 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11430 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11431 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433 ACL derivatives :
11434 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011436 Example :
11437 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11438 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11439 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011441path : string
11442 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11443 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11444 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11445 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11446 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11447 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11448 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011450 ACL derivatives :
11451 path : exact string match
11452 path_beg : prefix match
11453 path_dir : subdir match
11454 path_dom : domain match
11455 path_end : suffix match
11456 path_len : length match
11457 path_reg : regex match
11458 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011460req.ver : string
11461req_ver : string (deprecated)
11462 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11463 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11464 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011466 ACL derivatives :
11467 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011469res.comp : boolean
11470 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11471 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11472 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474res.comp_algo : string
11475 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11476 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11477 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011479res.cook([<name>]) : string
11480scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11481 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11482 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11483 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011485 ACL derivatives :
11486 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011488res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11489scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11490 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11491 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11492 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011494res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11495scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11496 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11497 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11498 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011500res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11501 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11502 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11503 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11504 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11505 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11506 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11507 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11508 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11509 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011511res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11512 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11513 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11514 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11515 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11516 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011518res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11519shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11520 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11521 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11522 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11523 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11524 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11525 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11526 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11527 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011529 ACL derivatives :
11530 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11531 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11532 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11533 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11534 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11535 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11536 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11537 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11538
11539res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11540shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11541 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11542 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11543 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11544 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11545 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011547res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11548shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11549 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11550 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11551 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11552 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11553 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11554 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011556res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11557shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11558 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11559 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11560 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11561 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11562 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11563 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565res.ver : string
11566resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11567 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11568 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011570 ACL derivatives :
11571 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011573set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11574 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11575 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11576 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11577 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011579 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11580 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011582 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584status : integer
11585 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11586 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11587 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011589url : string
11590 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11591 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11592 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11593 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11594 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11595 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11596 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011598 ACL derivatives :
11599 url : exact string match
11600 url_beg : prefix match
11601 url_dir : subdir match
11602 url_dom : domain match
11603 url_end : suffix match
11604 url_len : length match
11605 url_reg : regex match
11606 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011608url_ip : ip
11609 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11610 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11611 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11612 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11613 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11614 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11615 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617url_port : integer
11618 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11619 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11620 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11621 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011623urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11624url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11625 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11626 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11627 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11628 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11629 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11630 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11631 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11632 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11633 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011635 ACL derivatives :
11636 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11637 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11638 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11639 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11640 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11641 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11642 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11643 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011644
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011646 Example :
11647 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11648 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11649 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11650 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011652urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11653 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11654 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11655 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011656
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116587.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011659---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011661Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11662every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011663order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011665ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11666---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011667FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011668HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011669HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11670HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011671HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11672HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11673HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11674HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11675LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011676METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11677METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11678METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11679METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11680METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11681METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011682RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011683REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011684TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011685WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11686---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011687
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116898. Logging
11690----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011691
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011692One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11693provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11694very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11695provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11696state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011697to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011698headers.
11699
11700In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11701about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11702send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11703
11704 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11705 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11706 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11707 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11708 at the termination.
11709
11710The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11711allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11712as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11713while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11714real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11715delay.
11716
11717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117188.1. Log levels
11719---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011720
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011721TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011722source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011723HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11724in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11725track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11726syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11727about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011728
11729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117308.2. Log formats
11731----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011732
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011733HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011734and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11735slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11736options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011737
11738 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11739 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11740 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11741 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11742 extents.
11743
11744 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11745 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11746 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11747 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11748 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11749
11750 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11751 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11752 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11753 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11754 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11755
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011756 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11757 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11758 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11759 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11760
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011761 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11762
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011763Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11764specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11765field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11766servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11767always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11768identifier.
11769
11770Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11771 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11772 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11773 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11774 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11775
11776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117778.2.1. Default log format
11778-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011779
11780This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11781as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11782format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11783
11784 Example :
11785 listen www
11786 mode http
11787 log global
11788 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11789
11790 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11791 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11792 (www/HTTP)
11793
11794 Field Format Extract from the example above
11795 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11796 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11797 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11798 4 'to' to
11799 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11800 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11801
11802Detailed fields description :
11803 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11804 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11805 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11806 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11807 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11808 and processed the connection.
11809 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11810
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011811In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11812"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11813connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11814
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011815It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11816will eventually disappear.
11817
11818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118198.2.2. TCP log format
11820---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011821
11822The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11823is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11824information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11825counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11826emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11827environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11828the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11829sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011830specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11831not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11832fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11833marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011834
11835 Example :
11836 frontend fnt
11837 mode tcp
11838 option tcplog
11839 log global
11840 default_backend bck
11841
11842 backend bck
11843 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11844
11845 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11846 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11847 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11848
11849 Field Format Extract from the example above
11850 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11851 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11852 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11853 4 frontend_name fnt
11854 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11855 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11856 7 bytes_read* 212
11857 8 termination_state --
11858 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11859 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11860
11861Detailed fields description :
11862 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011863 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11864 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11865 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11866 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11867 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011868
11869 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011870 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11871 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11872 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011873
11874 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11875 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11876 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11877 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11878
11879 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11880 and processed the connection.
11881
11882 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11883 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11884 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11885 applications.
11886
11887 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11888 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11889 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11890 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11891 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11892
11893 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11894 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11895 See "Timers" below for more details.
11896
11897 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11898 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11899 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11900 "Timers" below for more details.
11901
11902 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011903 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011904 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11905 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11906 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11907 details.
11908
11909 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11910 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11911 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11912 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11913 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11914
11915 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11916 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11917 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11918 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11919 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11920 for more details.
11921
11922 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011923 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011924 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11925 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11926 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011927 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011928
11929 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11930 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11931 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11932 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11933 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11934 caused by a denial of service attack.
11935
11936 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11937 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11938 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11939 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11940 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11941 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11942 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11943 denial of service attack.
11944
11945 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11946 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11947 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11948 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11949 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11950 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11951 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11952 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11953 be processed than on other servers.
11954
11955 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11956 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11957 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11958 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11959 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11960 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11961 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11962 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11963 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11964 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11965 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11966 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11967 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11968
11969 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11970 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11971 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11972 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11973 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11974 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11975 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11976 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11977
11978 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11979 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11980 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11981 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11982 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11983 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11984 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11985 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11986 occurs.
11987
11988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119898.2.3. HTTP log format
11990----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011991
11992The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11993is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11994the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11995are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11996emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11997generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11998"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11999which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012000frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12001is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012002
12003Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12004slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12005with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12006
12007 Example :
12008 frontend http-in
12009 mode http
12010 option httplog
12011 log global
12012 default_backend bck
12013
12014 backend static
12015 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12016
12017 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12018 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12019 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012020 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012021
12022 Field Format Extract from the example above
12023 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12024 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12025 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12026 4 frontend_name http-in
12027 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12028 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12029 7 status_code 200
12030 8 bytes_read* 2750
12031 9 captured_request_cookie -
12032 10 captured_response_cookie -
12033 11 termination_state ----
12034 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12035 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12036 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12037 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12038 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012039
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012040
12041Detailed fields description :
12042 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012043 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12044 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12045 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12046 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12047 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012048
12049 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012050 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12051 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12052 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012053
12054 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12055 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12056 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12057 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12058 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12059
12060 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12061 and processed the connection.
12062
12063 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12064 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12065 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12066
12067 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12068 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12069 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12070 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12071 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12072 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12073
12074 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12075 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12076 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12077 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12078 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12079 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12080
12081 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12082 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12083 See "Timers" below for more details.
12084
12085 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12086 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12087 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12088 below for more details.
12089
12090 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12091 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12092 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12093 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12094 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12095 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12096 for more details.
12097
12098 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012099 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012100 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12101 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12102 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12103 details.
12104
12105 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12106 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12107 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12108
12109 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12110 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12111 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12112 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12113 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12114 overflowing.
12115
12116 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12117 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12118 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12119 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12120 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12121 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12122 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12123 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12124
12125 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12126 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12127 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12128 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12129 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12130 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12131 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12132 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12133
12134 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12135 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12136 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12137 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12138 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12139 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12140 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12141
12142 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012143 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012144 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12145 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12146 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012147 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012148 system.
12149
12150 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12151 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12152 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12153 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12154 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12155 caused by a denial of service attack.
12156
12157 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12158 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12159 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12160 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12161 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12162 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12163 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12164 denial of service attack.
12165
12166 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12167 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12168 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12169 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12170 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12171 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12172 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12173 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12174 processed than on other servers.
12175
12176 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12177 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12178 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12179 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12180 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12181 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12182 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12183 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12184 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12185 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12186 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12187 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12188 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12189
12190 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12191 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12192 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12193 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12194 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12195 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12196 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12197 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12198
12199 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12200 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12201 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12202 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12203 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12204 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12205 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12206 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12207 occurs.
12208
12209 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12210 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12211 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12212 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12213 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12214 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12215 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12216 cookies" below for more details.
12217
12218 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12219 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12220 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12221 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12222 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12223 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12224 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12225 and cookies" below for more details.
12226
12227 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12228 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12229 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12230 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12231 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12232 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12233 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12234 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12235
12236
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122378.2.4. Custom log format
12238------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012239
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012240The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012241mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012242
12243HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12244Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12245separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12246prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12247
12248Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12249variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12250string formats ("Q").
12251
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012252If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012253as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012254less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12255the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12256
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012257Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012258In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012259in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012260
12261Flags are :
12262 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012263 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012264
12265 Example:
12266
12267 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12268 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12269
12270At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12271
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012272 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12273 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012274
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012275the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012276
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012277 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012278 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012279 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012280
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012281and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12282
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012283 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012284 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12285
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012286Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12287
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012288 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012289 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012290 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12291 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12292 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012293 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12294 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12295 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012296 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012297 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012298 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012299 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012300 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012301 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012302 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12303 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012304 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012305 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12306 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012307 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012308 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12309 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012310 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12311 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12312 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012313 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012314 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12315 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012316 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012317 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12318 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12319 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012320 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012321 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12322 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12323 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12324 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012325 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012326 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012327 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012328 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012329 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012330 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012331 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12332 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12333 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012334 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012335 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12336 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012337 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012338 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012339 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012340 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012341
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012342 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012343
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012344
123458.2.5. Error log format
12346-----------------------
12347
12348When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12349protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12350By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12351"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12352will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12353logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12354
12355The format looks like this :
12356
12357 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12358 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12359 Connection error during SSL handshake
12360
12361 Field Format Extract from the example above
12362 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12363 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12364 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12365 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12366 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12367
12368These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12369failures.
12370
12371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123728.3. Advanced logging options
12373-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012374
12375Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12376just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12377options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12378for more information about their usage.
12379
12380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12382------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012383
12384It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12385haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12386commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12387monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12388ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12389
12390 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12391 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12392 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12393 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12394
12395 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12396 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12397 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012398 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012399 such as other load-balancers.
12400
12401 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12402 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12403 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12404
12405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12407----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012408
12409The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12410what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12411or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12412"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12413just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12414log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12415after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12416is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12417with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12418with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12419
12420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124218.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12422------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012423
12424Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12425for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12426"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12427retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12428raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12429a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12430file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12431you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12432"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12433
12434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124358.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12436--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012437
12438Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12439multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12440them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12441"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12442logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12443error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12444and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12445too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12446useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12447alternative.
12448
12449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124508.4. Timing events
12451------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012452
12453Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12454reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12455the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12456frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12457mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12458
12459 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12460 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12461 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12462 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12463 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12464
12465 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12466 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12467 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12468 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12469 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12470
12471 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12472 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12473 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12474 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12475 connection never established.
12476
12477 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12478 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12479 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12480 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12481 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12482 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12483 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12484 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12485 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12486 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12487 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12488
12489 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12490 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12491 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12492 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012493 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012494
12495 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12496
12497 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12498 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12499 negative.
12500
12501These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12502protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12503that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012504due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012505close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12506session has been aborted on timeout.
12507
12508Most common cases :
12509
12510 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12511 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12512 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12513 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12514 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12515 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12516 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12517 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12518 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012519 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12520 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12521 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012522
12523 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12524 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12525 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12526 of ms on remote networks.
12527
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012528 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12529 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12530 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012531
12532 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12533 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12534 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12535 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12536 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12537 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12538 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12539 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12540 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12541 to the server until another one is released.
12542
12543Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12544
12545 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12546 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12547 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12548
12549 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12550 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12551 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12552
12553 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12554 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12555 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12556 flags.
12557
12558 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12559 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12560 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12561 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12562 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12563 the client connection was maintained open.
12564
12565 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012566 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012567 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12568 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12569
12570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125718.5. Session state at disconnection
12572-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012573
12574TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12575"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125762-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12577each of which has a special meaning :
12578
12579 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12580 session to terminate :
12581
12582 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12583
12584 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12585 server explicitly refused it.
12586
12587 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12588 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12589 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12590 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012591 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12592
12593 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12594 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012595
12596 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12597 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12598 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12599 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12600 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12601
12602 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12603 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12604 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12605 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12606 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12607
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012608 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12609 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12610
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012611 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12612 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12613 backup connections when going up.
12614
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012615 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12616
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012617 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12618 send or receive data.
12619
12620 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12621 send or receive data.
12622
12623 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12624 with nothing left in the buffers.
12625
12626 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12627
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012628 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012629 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12630
12631 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12632 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12633 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12634 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12635 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12636
12637 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12638 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12639
12640 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12641 server (HTTP only).
12642
12643 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12644
12645 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12646 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12647 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12648
12649 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12650 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12651 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12652
12653 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12654
12655 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12656 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12657
12658 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12659 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12660 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12661
12662 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12663 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012664 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12665 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012666
12667 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12668 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12669 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12670 another server.
12671
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012672 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012673 server.
12674
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012675 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12676 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12677 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12678 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12679
12680 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12681 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12682 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12683 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12684
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012685 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12686 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12687 "use-server" rule).
12688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012689 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12690
12691 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12692 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12693
12694 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12695
12696 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12697 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12698 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12699
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012700 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12701 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012702 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012703 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12704 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12705
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012706 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12707
12708 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12709 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12710
12711 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12712
12713 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12714
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012715The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12716was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012717helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12718starvation, attacks, etc...
12719
12720The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12721alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12722easier finding and understanding.
12723
12724 Flags Reason
12725
12726 -- Normal termination.
12727
12728 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12729 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12730 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12731 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12732
12733 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12734 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12735 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12736 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12737 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12738 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012739
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012740 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12741 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012742 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012743
12744 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12745 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12746 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12747
12748 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12749 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12750 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12751 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12752 the server takes too long to respond.
12753
12754 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12755 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12756 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12757 long a time to respond.
12758
12759 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12760 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12761 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12762 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12763 and the client.
12764
12765 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12766 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12767 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12768 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12769 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012770 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12771 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12772 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12773 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12774 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12775 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12776 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12777 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12778 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12779 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12780 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12781 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12782 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12783 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012784
12785 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12786 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012787 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12788 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12789 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12790 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012791
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012792 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12793 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012795 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012796 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12797 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12798 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12799 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12800 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12801
12802 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12803 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12804 503 or 504 here.
12805
12806 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12807 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12808 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12809 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12810 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12811
12812 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12813 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012814 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012815 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12816 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12817
12818 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12819 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12820 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12821 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12822 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12823 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12824 between haproxy and the server.
12825
12826 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12827 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12828 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12829 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12830 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12831 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12832 solution is to fix the application.
12833
12834 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12835 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12836 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12837 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12838 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12839 external attacks.
12840
12841 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12842 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012843 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012844 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12845 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12846
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012847 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12848 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12849 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012850 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12851 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012852
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012853 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12854 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12855 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12856 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012857 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12858 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12859 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12860 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12861 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012862
12863 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12864 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12865 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12866 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12867
12868 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12869 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12870 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12871 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12872
12873 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12874 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12875 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12876 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12877
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012878The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12879persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12880important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12881re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12882
12883 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12884
12885 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12886 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12887 set on a GET request.
12888
12889 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12890 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012891 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012892 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12893
12894 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12895 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12896 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12897
12898 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12899 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12900 already got a cookie.
12901
12902 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12903 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12904 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12905 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12906 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12907
12908 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12909 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12910 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12911
12912 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12913 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12914 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12915
12916 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12917 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12918
12919 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12920 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12921 then advertised in the response.
12922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129248.6. Non-printable characters
12925-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012926
12927In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12928consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12929converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12930prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12931being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12932escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12933is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12934'}' when logging headers.
12935
12936Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12937issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12938containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12939
12940Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12941the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12942performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12943
12944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129458.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12946---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012947
12948Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12949achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012950section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012951cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12952the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12953the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012954locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012955not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12956user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12957a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12958wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12959
12960 Examples :
12961 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12962 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12963
12964 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12965 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12966
12967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129688.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12969---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012970
12971Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12972proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12973the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12974server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12975
12976Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12977response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012978section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012979
12980It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012981time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12982appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012983are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12984and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12985follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12986request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12987in the logs.
12988
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012989As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12990frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12991an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12992
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012993 Example :
12994 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12995 listen proxy-out
12996 mode http
12997 option httplog
12998 option logasap
12999 log global
13000 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13001
13002 # log the name of the virtual server
13003 capture request header Host len 20
13004
13005 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13006 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13007
13008 # log the beginning of the referrer
13009 capture request header Referer len 20
13010
13011 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13012 capture response header Server len 20
13013
13014 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13015 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13016
13017 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13018 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13019
13020 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13021 capture response header Via len 20
13022
13023 # log the URL location during a redirection
13024 capture response header Location len 20
13025
13026 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13027 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13028 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13029 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13030 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13031
13032 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13033 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13034 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13035 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013036 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013037
13038 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13039 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13040 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13041 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13042 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013043 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013044
13045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130468.9. Examples of logs
13047---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013048
13049These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13050them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13051reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13052
13053 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13054 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13055 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13056
13057 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13058 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13059
13060 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13061 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13062 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13063
13064 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13065 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13066
13067 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13068 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13069 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13070
13071 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013072 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013073 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13074 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13075
13076 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13077 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13078 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13079
13080 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13081 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013082 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013083 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13084 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13085 to return the 502 and not the server.
13086
13087 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013088 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013089
13090 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13091 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13092 Nothing was sent to any server.
13093
13094 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13095 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13096
13097 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13098 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13099 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13100 send a 408 return code to the client.
13101
13102 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13103 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13104
13105 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13106 5 seconds ("c----").
13107
13108 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13109 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013110 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013111
13112 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013113 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013114 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13115 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13116 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13117 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13118 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013119
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131219. Statistics and monitoring
13122----------------------------
13123
13124It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13125mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13126CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13127Unix socket.
13128
13129
131309.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013131---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013132
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013133The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013134page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13135begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13136represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13137use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13138('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13139(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13140text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13141do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13142use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013143
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013144In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13145that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13146S (Servers).
13147
13148 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13149 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13150 any name for server/listener)
13151 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13152 number queued without a server assigned.
13153 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13154 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13155 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13156 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13157 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13158 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13159 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13160 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13161 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13162 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13163 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13164 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13165 "option checkcache".
13166 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13167 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13168 - read error from the client
13169 - client timeout
13170 - client closed connection
13171 - various bad requests from the client.
13172 - request was tarpitted.
13173 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13174 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13175 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13176 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13177 active servers).
13178 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13179 Some other errors are:
13180 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13181 - failure applying filters to the response.
13182 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13183 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13184 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13185 switched away from.
13186 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13187 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13188 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13189 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13190 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13191 the server is up.)
13192 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13193 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13194 counters for each server.
13195 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13196 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13197 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13198 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13199 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13200 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13201 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13202 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13203 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13204 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13205 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13206 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13207 of times that server was selected.
13208 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13209 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13210 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13211 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13212 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13213 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013214 UNK -> unknown
13215 INI -> initializing
13216 SOCKERR -> socket error
13217 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13218 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13219 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13220 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13221 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13222 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13223 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13224 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13225 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13226 disable-on-404
13227 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13228 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13229 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013230 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13231 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13232 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13233 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13234 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13235 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13236 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13237 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13238 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13239 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13240 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13241 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13242 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13243 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13244 (inc. in eresp)
13245 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13246 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13247 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13248 (CPU/BW limit)
13249 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13250 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13251 server/backend
13252 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13253 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13254 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13255 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13256 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13257 (0 for TCP)
13258 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13259 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013260
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132629.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013263-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013264
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013265The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13266necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13267A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13268issuing commands by hand :
13269
13270 global
13271 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13272 stats timeout 2m
13273
13274It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13275the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13276never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13277situations :
13278
13279 global
13280 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13281 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13282 stats timeout 2m
13283
13284To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13285swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13286to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13287syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13288
13289 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13290 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13291
13292The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13293script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13294for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13295
13296The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13297that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13298editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13299(eg: watch a counter).
13300
13301The socket supports two operation modes :
13302 - interactive
13303 - non-interactive
13304
13305The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13306this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13307sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13308mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13309commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13310example :
13311
13312 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13313
13314The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13315entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13316for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13317sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13318"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13319after processing the last command of the same line.
13320
13321For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13322"prompt" command :
13323
13324 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13325 prompt
13326 > show info
13327 ...
13328 >
13329
13330Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13331delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13332that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13333parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013334
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013335It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13336on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13337own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013338
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013339The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13340If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13341all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13342it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13343
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013344add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013345 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13346 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13347 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13348 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013349
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013350add map <map> <key> <value>
13351 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13352 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013353 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13354 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13355 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013356
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013357clear counters
13358 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13359 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13360 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13361 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13362 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13363
13364clear counters all
13365 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13366 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13367 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13368
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013369clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013370 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13371 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13372 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013373
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013374clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013375 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13376 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13377 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013378
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013379clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13380 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13381
13382 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13383 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13384 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13385 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13386 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13387 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13388
13389 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13390
13391 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13392 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13393 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13394 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13395 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13396 the ACLs :
13397
13398 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13399 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13400 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13401 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13402 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13403 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13404
13405 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013406 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13407 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013408
13409 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013410 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013411 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013412 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13413 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13414 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13415 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013416
13417 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13418
13419 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013420 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013421 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13422 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013423 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13424 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13425 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013426
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013427del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13428 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013429 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13430 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13431 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13432 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013433
13434del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013435 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013436 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13437 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13438 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13439 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013440
13441disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013442 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13443
13444 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13445 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13446 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13447 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13448 re-enabled using enable agent.
13449
13450 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13451 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13452 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13453 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13454 otherwise unchanged.
13455
13456 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13457 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13458 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13459
13460 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13461 level "admin".
13462
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013463disable frontend <frontend>
13464 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13465 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13466 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13467 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13468 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13469 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13470 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13471 on the stats page.
13472
13473 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13474 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13475
13476 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13477 level "admin".
13478
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013479disable health <backend>/<server>
13480 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13481 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13482 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13483 agent check forces it down.
13484
13485 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13486 level "admin".
13487
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013488disable server <backend>/<server>
13489 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13490 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13491 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13492 during the maintenance.
13493
13494 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13495 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13496
13497 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013498 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013499
13500 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13501 level "admin".
13502
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013503enable agent <backend>/<server>
13504 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13505
13506 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13507 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13508
13509 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13510 level "admin".
13511
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013512enable frontend <frontend>
13513 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13514 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13515 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13516 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13517 which was disabled.
13518
13519 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13520 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13521
13522 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13523 level "admin".
13524
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013525enable health <backend>/<server>
13526 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13527 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13528
13529 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13530 level "admin".
13531
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013532enable server <backend>/<server>
13533 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13534 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13535
13536 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013537 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013538
13539 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13540 level "admin".
13541
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013542get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013543get acl <acl> <value>
13544 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13545 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13546 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13547 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13548 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013549
13550 The first two words are:
13551
13552 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13553 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13554 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13555
13556 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13557
13558 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13559
13560 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13561
13562 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13563 interpretation of the case.
13564
13565 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13566 useful with regular expressions.
13567
13568 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13569 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13570
13571 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13572 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13573 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13574
13575 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13576
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013577get weight <backend>/<server>
13578 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13579 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13580 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13581 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13582 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013583 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013584
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013585help
13586 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13587 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013588
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013589prompt
13590 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13591 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13592 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13593 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13594 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13595 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13596 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13597 command.
13598
13599quit
13600 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013601
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013602set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013603 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13604 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13605 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013606
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013607set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013608 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13609 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13610 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13611 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13612 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013613 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13614 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13615
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013616set maxconn global <maxconn>
13617 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13618 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13619 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13620 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13621 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13622 setting.
13623
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013624set rate-limit connections global <value>
13625 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13626 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13627 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13628 is passed in number of connections per second.
13629
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013630set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13631 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13632 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013633 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13634 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013635
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013636set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13637 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13638 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13639 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13640 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13641
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013642set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13643 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13644 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13645 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13646 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13647 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13648
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013649set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13650 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13651 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13652 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13653
13654set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13655 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13656 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13657 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13658
13659set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13660 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13661 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13662 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13663 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13664 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13665 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13666 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13667 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13668
13669set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13670 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13671 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13672
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013673set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13674 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13675 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13676 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13677 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13678
13679 Example:
13680 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13681 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13682 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13683 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13684
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013685set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013686 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13687 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13688 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13689 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013690 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13691 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013692
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013693set timeout cli <delay>
13694 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13695 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13696 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13697
13698set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13699 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13700 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013701 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13702 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13703 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13704 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13705 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13706 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13707 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13708 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13709 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13710 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13711 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13712 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13713 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013714
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013715show errors [<iid>]
13716 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13717 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013718 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13719 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13720 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013721
13722 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13723 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13724 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13725 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13726 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13727 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13728 are reported too.
13729
13730 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13731 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13732 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13733 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13734 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13735 code.
13736
13737 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13738 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13739 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13740 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13741 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13742 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13743 line.
13744
13745 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013746 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13747 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013748 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13749 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13750
13751 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13752 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13753 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13754 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13755 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13756 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13757 00204+ minal\r\n
13758 00211 \r\n
13759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013760 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013761 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13762 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13763 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13764 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13765 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13766 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013767
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013768show info
13769 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13770
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013771show map [<map>]
13772 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013773 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13774 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13775 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13776 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13777 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13778 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013779
13780show acl [<acl>]
13781 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013782 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13783 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13784 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13785 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13786 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013787
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013788show pools
13789 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13790 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13791 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13792 the pools.
13793
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013794show sess
13795 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013796 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13797 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13798
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013799show sess <id>
13800 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13801 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13802 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13803 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13804 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013805 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13806 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13807
13808 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13809 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013810
13811show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13812 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13813 possible to dump only selected items :
13814 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13815 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13816 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13817 for example:
13818 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13819 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13820 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13821
13822 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013823 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13824 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013825 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13826 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13827 Nbproc: 1
13828 Process_num: 1
13829 (...)
13830
13831 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13832 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13833 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13834 (...)
13835 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13836
13837 $
13838
13839 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13840 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13841 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13842 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013843 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013844
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013845show table
13846 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13847 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13848 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13849 entries currently in use.
13850
13851 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013852 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013853 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13854 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013855
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013856show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013857 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13858 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13859 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013860 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13861
13862 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13863 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13864 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13865 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13866 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13867
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013868 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13869 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13870 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13871 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13872 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13873 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13874
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013875
13876 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013877 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13878 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013879
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013880 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013881 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013882 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013883 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13884 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13885 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13886 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013887
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013888 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013889 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013890 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13891 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013892
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013893 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13894 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013895 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013896 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13897 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013898
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013899 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13900 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013901 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013902 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13903 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13904
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013905 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13906 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13907 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13908 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13909 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13910
13911 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13912 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13913 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013914 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13915 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013916 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13917 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013918
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013919shutdown frontend <frontend>
13920 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13921 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13922 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13923 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13924 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13925 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13926 once it is terminated.
13927
13928 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13929 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13930
13931 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13932 level "admin".
13933
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013934shutdown session <id>
13935 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13936 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13937 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13938 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13939 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13940 flag in the logs.
13941
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013942shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013943 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13944 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13945 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13946 'K' flag in the logs.
13947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013948/*
13949 * Local variables:
13950 * fill-column: 79
13951 * End:
13952 */